1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.92"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
374 .cindex "documentation"
375 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
376 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
377 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
378 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
381 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
382 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
383 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
384 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
385 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
386 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 .cindex "books about Exim"
390 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
391 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
392 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
393 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
395 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
396 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
397 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
398 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
400 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
401 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
402 Debian-specific features in the file
403 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
404 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
408 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
410 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
411 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
412 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
413 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
414 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
416 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
417 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
418 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
419 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
421 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
422 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
424 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
425 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
426 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
430 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
431 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
432 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
433 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
434 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
435 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
437 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
441 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
442 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
446 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
449 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
450 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
451 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
455 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
456 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
457 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
458 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
459 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
461 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
465 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
476 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
477 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
478 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
490 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
493 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
494 .cindex "bug reports"
495 .cindex "reporting bugs"
496 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
497 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
498 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
499 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
505 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
506 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
507 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
508 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
510 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
512 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
513 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
515 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
516 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
517 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
519 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
520 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
521 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
522 here are top-level directories.
524 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
527 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
534 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
536 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
537 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
538 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
539 most portable to old systems.
541 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
542 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
543 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
544 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
545 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
546 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
547 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
548 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
549 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
550 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
551 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
553 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
554 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
555 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
556 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
558 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
560 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
561 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
565 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
566 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
569 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
570 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
571 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
579 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
585 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
586 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
587 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
588 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
589 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
590 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .cindex "domainless addresses"
593 .cindex "address" "without domain"
594 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
595 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
596 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
597 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600 .cindex "transport" "external"
601 .cindex "external transports"
602 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
603 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
604 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
605 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
606 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
607 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
610 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
611 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
615 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
616 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
617 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
618 a number of common scanners are provided.
622 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
623 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
624 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
625 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
626 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
627 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
631 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
632 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
633 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
634 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
635 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
636 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
637 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
638 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
639 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
640 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
641 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
644 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
645 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
646 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
650 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
651 .cindex "terminology definitions"
652 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
653 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
654 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
655 below) by a blank line.
657 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
658 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
659 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
660 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
661 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
662 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
663 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
664 rise to further bounce messages.
666 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
667 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
668 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
672 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
673 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
677 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
678 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
681 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
682 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
683 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
684 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
685 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
686 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
687 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
690 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
691 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
692 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
693 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
694 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
698 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
699 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
700 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
701 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
704 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
705 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
706 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
707 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
708 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
711 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
715 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
716 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
717 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
718 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
721 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
722 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
723 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
724 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
727 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
728 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
729 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
730 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
731 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
742 .cindex "incorporated code"
743 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
750 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
751 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
752 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
753 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
754 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
757 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
758 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
759 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
760 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
761 following statements:
764 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
767 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
768 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
771 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
772 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
773 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
774 restrictions applied to it).
777 .cindex "SPA authentication"
778 .cindex "Samba project"
779 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
780 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
781 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
782 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
786 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
787 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
788 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
789 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
790 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
791 conditions expressed therein.
794 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
797 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
801 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
802 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
805 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
806 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
810 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
811 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
812 details, please contact
814 Office of Technology Transfer
815 Carnegie Mellon University
817 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
818 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
819 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
826 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
829 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
830 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
831 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
832 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
833 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
834 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
839 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
843 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
844 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
845 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
849 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
853 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
854 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
855 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
856 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
857 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
858 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
859 software without specific, written prior permission.
861 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
862 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
863 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
864 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
865 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
866 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
871 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
872 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
873 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
874 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
875 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
879 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
880 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
881 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
892 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
896 .cindex "design philosophy"
897 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
898 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
899 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
900 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
901 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
902 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
906 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
907 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
908 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
909 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
910 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
911 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
915 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
916 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
917 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
918 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
919 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
920 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
921 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
922 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
926 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
929 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
930 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
931 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
934 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
935 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
936 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
937 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
940 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
941 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
944 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
945 runs at the start of every delivery process.
950 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
951 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
952 .cindex "Sieve filter"
953 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
954 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
955 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
956 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
957 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
958 of filtering are available:
961 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
965 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
972 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
973 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
974 .cindex "format" "of message id"
975 .cindex "id of message"
980 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
981 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
982 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
983 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
984 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
985 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
986 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
987 not always case-sensitive.
989 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
990 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
991 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
992 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
993 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
994 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
998 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
999 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1000 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1001 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1004 received the message.
1006 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1009 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1010 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1011 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1012 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1015 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1016 (1/100) of a second.
1020 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1028 .cindex "receiving mail"
1029 .cindex "message" "reception"
1030 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1031 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1032 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1033 there are several possibilities:
1036 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1037 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1038 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1041 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1042 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1043 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1044 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1045 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1048 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1049 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1050 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1051 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1054 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1055 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1056 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1060 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1061 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1062 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1063 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1064 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1065 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1066 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1067 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1068 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1069 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1070 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1071 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1072 users to change sender addresses.
1074 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1075 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1076 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1077 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1078 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1079 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1080 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1083 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1084 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1085 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1086 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1087 message is received.
1093 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1094 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1095 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1096 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1097 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1098 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1099 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1100 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1103 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1104 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1105 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1106 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1107 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1108 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1109 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1110 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1111 affect file system performance.
1113 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1114 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1115 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1116 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1117 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1120 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1121 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1122 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1123 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1124 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1125 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1126 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1127 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1128 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1129 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1130 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1134 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1135 .cindex "message" "life of"
1136 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1137 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1138 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1139 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1140 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1141 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1142 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1145 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1146 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1147 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1148 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1152 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1153 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1154 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1155 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1157 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1158 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1159 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1160 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1161 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1162 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1163 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1164 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1165 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1166 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169 .cindex "journal file"
1170 .cindex "file" "journal"
1171 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1172 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1173 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1174 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1175 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1176 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1177 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1178 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1181 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1182 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1183 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1184 deliveries caused by crashes.
1188 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1189 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1190 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1192 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1193 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1194 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1195 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1196 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1199 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1200 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1201 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1202 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1203 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1204 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1205 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1206 the driver's features in general.
1208 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1209 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1210 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1211 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1215 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1216 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1217 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1218 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1219 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1222 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1223 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1224 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1225 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1226 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1229 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1230 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1234 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1235 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1236 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1237 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1238 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1239 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1240 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1241 configured to fail the address.
1243 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1244 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1245 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1246 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1247 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1248 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1251 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1252 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1253 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1254 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1255 the address is bounced.
1259 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1260 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1261 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1262 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1263 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1264 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1265 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1266 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1269 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1270 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1271 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1272 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1273 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1274 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1275 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1280 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1281 .cindex "router" "running details"
1282 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1283 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1284 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1285 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1286 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1287 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1291 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1292 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1293 original address ceases
1294 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1295 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1296 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1297 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1298 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1302 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1303 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1304 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1305 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1308 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1309 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1310 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1311 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1314 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1315 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1316 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1317 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1320 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1321 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1324 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1325 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1326 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1329 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1333 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1334 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1335 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1336 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1339 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1340 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1341 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1342 facility for this purpose.
1345 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1346 .cindex "case of local parts"
1347 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1348 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1349 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1350 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1351 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1352 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1353 routed addresses are shown.
1357 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1358 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1359 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1360 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1361 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1362 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1403 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1414 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418 remaining preconditions.
1420 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424 could lead to confusion.
1426 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427 set of addresses that it defines.
1429 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430 specified files is tested.
1432 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1439 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1449 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1454 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1460 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1463 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1471 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1472 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475 processed entirely independently of each other.
1477 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1487 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494 addresses to the same domain.
1496 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1505 .cindex "queue runner"
1506 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1516 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1523 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526 messages to other addresses.
1528 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1533 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1541 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544 .cindex "queue runner"
1545 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1551 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552 passed its retry time.
1553 You can run several queue runners at once.
1555 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1564 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1575 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1579 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1588 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1600 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1605 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1616 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1620 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1632 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1635 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1641 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1644 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1651 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652 following subdirectories are created:
1655 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1664 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1665 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666 that may be useful to some sites.
1669 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1676 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680 overridden if necessary.
1681 .cindex compiler requirements
1682 .cindex compiler version
1683 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1686 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687 .cindex "PCRE library"
1688 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1690 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1691 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696 If your operating system has no
1697 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1701 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1709 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1718 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725 Berkeley DB library.
1727 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1732 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1735 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739 filename is used unmodified.
1741 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1746 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1750 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1752 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1753 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1754 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1755 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1756 page with far newer versions listed.
1757 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1758 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1759 suited to Exim's usage model.
1761 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1762 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1763 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1764 operates on a single file.
1768 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1769 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1770 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1771 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1772 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1776 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1777 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1779 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1780 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1781 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1782 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1783 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1784 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1786 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1787 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1788 in one of these lines:
1793 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1794 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1795 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1796 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1799 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1800 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1802 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1803 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1807 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1808 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1809 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1810 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1811 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1812 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1813 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1814 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1815 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1816 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1817 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1818 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1820 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1821 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1822 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1823 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1824 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1825 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1827 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1828 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1829 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1830 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1831 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1832 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1835 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1836 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1837 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1838 facilities, you need to set
1840 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1842 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1843 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1846 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1847 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1848 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1849 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1850 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1851 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1852 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1854 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1855 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1856 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1857 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1858 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1863 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1864 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1866 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1867 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1868 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1869 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1870 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1871 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1872 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1874 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1875 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1876 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1877 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1878 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1882 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1886 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1887 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1888 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1889 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1890 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1891 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1892 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1893 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1894 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1895 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1898 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1899 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1902 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1905 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1907 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1908 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1911 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1912 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1914 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1915 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1918 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1920 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1921 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1925 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1927 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1928 library and include files. For example:
1932 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1933 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1935 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1936 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1940 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1943 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1944 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1945 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1950 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1952 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1953 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1954 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1955 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1956 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1957 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1958 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1959 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1960 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1961 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1962 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1963 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1966 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1967 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1968 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1970 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1971 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1973 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1975 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1976 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1977 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1978 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1979 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1980 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1984 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1985 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1986 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1987 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1988 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1989 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1992 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1993 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1994 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1995 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1996 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1998 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2003 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2004 .cindex "lookup modules"
2005 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2006 .cindex ".so building"
2007 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2008 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2010 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2011 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2013 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2015 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2016 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2017 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2018 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2019 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2020 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2022 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2023 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2024 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2033 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2034 .cindex "build directory"
2035 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2036 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2037 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2038 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2039 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2040 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2041 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2043 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2044 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2045 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2046 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2047 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2048 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2049 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2050 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2052 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2053 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2054 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2058 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2059 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2060 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2061 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2062 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2063 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2064 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2068 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2069 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2070 given in addition to the short output.
2074 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2075 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2076 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2077 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2078 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2079 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2080 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2083 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2084 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2086 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2087 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2088 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2089 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2091 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2092 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2093 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2094 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2095 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2096 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2097 and are often not needed.
2099 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2100 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2101 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2102 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2103 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2104 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2105 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2106 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2107 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2110 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2111 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2112 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2113 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2117 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2118 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2119 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2120 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2121 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2122 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2123 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2124 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2125 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2126 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2127 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2128 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2129 containing the lines
2134 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2135 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2137 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2138 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2139 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2142 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2143 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2144 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2145 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2146 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2147 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2148 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2149 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2150 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2151 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2157 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2158 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2159 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2160 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2161 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2162 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2163 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2164 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2167 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2168 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2169 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2170 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2171 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2172 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2173 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2174 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2175 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2176 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2177 syntax. For instance:
2180 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2182 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2183 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2184 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2187 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2188 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2189 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2193 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2194 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2196 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2197 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2198 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2199 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2200 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2201 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2204 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2205 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2207 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2208 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2211 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2212 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2214 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2215 definition of all three of these variables into your
2216 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2219 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2220 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2221 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2222 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2224 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2225 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2226 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2227 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2228 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2231 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2232 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2233 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2234 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2235 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2238 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2240 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2241 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2242 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2243 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2244 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2245 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2249 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2250 .cindex "building Eximon"
2251 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2252 where the files that are involved are
2254 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2256 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2257 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2258 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2259 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2261 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2262 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2263 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2264 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2265 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2266 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2267 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2271 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2272 .cindex "installing Exim"
2273 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2274 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2275 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2276 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2277 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2278 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2279 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2280 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2281 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2282 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2283 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2284 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2286 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2287 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2288 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2289 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2290 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2291 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2292 alternative files, no default is installed.
2294 .cindex "system aliases file"
2295 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2296 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2297 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2298 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2299 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2300 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2301 and outputs a comment to the user.
2303 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2304 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2305 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2306 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2307 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2309 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2310 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2311 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2312 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2313 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2316 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2317 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2320 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2322 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2323 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2324 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2325 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2326 but this usage is deprecated.
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2329 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2330 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2331 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2332 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2333 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2335 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2336 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2337 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2338 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2339 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2340 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2341 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2344 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2345 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2348 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2350 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2351 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2352 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2353 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2356 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2358 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2359 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2362 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2363 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2365 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2369 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2371 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2373 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2374 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2375 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2377 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2382 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2383 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2384 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2385 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2386 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2389 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2390 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2391 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2395 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2396 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2397 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2398 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2399 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2405 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2406 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2407 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2408 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2409 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2413 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2414 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2415 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2416 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2417 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2420 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2422 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2424 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2426 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2427 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2428 user agent. For example:
2430 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2431 From: user@your.domain.example
2432 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2433 Subject: Testing Exim
2435 This is a test message.
2438 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2439 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2440 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2442 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2443 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2444 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2445 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2446 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2447 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2449 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2451 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2452 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2453 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2454 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2455 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2457 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2458 .cindex "lock files"
2459 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2460 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2461 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2462 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2463 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2464 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2465 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2466 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2467 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2468 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2469 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2470 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2472 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2473 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2474 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2475 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2476 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2479 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2480 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2481 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2482 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2486 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2487 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2488 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2489 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2490 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2491 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2492 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2493 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2494 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2495 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2496 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2497 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2498 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2500 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2501 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2502 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2503 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2504 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2505 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2508 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2509 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2510 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2511 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2513 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2514 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2515 favourite user agent.
2517 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2518 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2519 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2520 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2521 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2522 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2526 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2527 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2528 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2529 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2530 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2531 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2532 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2533 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2539 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2540 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2541 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2543 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2545 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2546 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2547 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2548 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2549 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2551 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2553 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2555 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2556 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2557 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2565 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2566 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2567 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2568 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2569 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2570 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2571 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2572 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2573 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2576 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2578 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2579 were present before any other options.
2580 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2582 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2583 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2584 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2587 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2588 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2589 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2593 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2594 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2595 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2598 .cindex "queue runner"
2599 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2600 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2601 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2603 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2604 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2605 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2606 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2607 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2608 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2609 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2610 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2613 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2614 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2615 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2616 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2617 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2618 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2621 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2622 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2623 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2624 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2625 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2626 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2628 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2629 .cindex "envelope from"
2630 .cindex "envelope sender"
2631 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2632 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2633 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2634 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2635 users to set envelope senders.
2637 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2638 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2639 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2640 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2641 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2642 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2643 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2645 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2646 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2647 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2648 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2649 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2650 that are available to trusted users.
2652 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2653 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2654 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2655 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2656 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2658 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2659 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2660 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2661 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2663 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2664 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2665 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2666 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2668 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2669 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2674 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2675 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2676 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2682 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2683 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2684 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2685 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2686 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2687 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2688 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2689 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2691 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2692 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2693 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2694 . creates a man page for the options.
2695 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2698 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2705 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2706 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2707 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2708 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2711 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2712 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2713 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2716 .vitem &%--version%&
2717 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2718 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2725 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2728 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2730 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2731 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2732 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2733 clean; it ignores this option.
2738 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2739 .cindex "queue runner"
2740 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2741 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2742 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2744 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2745 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2746 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2747 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2749 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2750 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2751 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2752 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2754 When a listening daemon
2755 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2756 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2757 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2758 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2759 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2760 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2763 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2764 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2765 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2769 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2770 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2771 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2772 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2773 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2774 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2775 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2776 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2777 because these are reread each time they are used.
2781 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2782 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2786 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2787 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2788 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2789 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2790 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2791 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2793 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2794 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2795 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2796 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2797 test data. A line history is supported.
2799 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2800 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2801 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2802 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2803 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2804 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2805 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2807 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2808 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2809 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2810 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2812 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2813 defined and macros will be expanded.
2814 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2815 available to admin users.
2817 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2819 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2820 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2821 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2822 of a file. For example:
2824 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2826 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2827 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2828 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2829 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2830 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2831 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2832 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2835 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2837 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2838 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2839 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2840 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2841 system filters are recognized.
2843 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2845 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2846 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2847 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2848 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2849 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2850 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2851 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2852 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2855 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2856 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2857 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2859 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2861 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2862 variables that are used by the user filter.
2864 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2869 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2870 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2871 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2874 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2875 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2876 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2877 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2879 When testing a filter file,
2880 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2881 .cindex "envelope from"
2882 .cindex "envelope sender"
2883 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2884 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2885 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2886 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2887 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2890 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2892 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2893 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2894 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2897 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2899 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2900 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2901 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2902 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2903 actually being delivered.
2905 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2907 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2908 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2909 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2912 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2914 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2915 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2916 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2919 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2921 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2922 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2923 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2924 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2925 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2926 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2927 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2928 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2929 after a full stop. For example:
2931 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2932 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2934 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2935 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2936 conversion to the canonical form is
2937 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2939 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2940 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2941 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2942 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2943 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2947 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2948 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2949 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2952 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2953 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2954 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2956 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2957 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2958 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2959 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2960 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2961 session were authenticated.
2963 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2964 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2965 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2967 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2968 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2969 specialized SMTP test program such as
2970 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2972 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2974 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2975 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2976 updating the callout cache database.
2980 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2981 .cindex "building alias file"
2982 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2983 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2984 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2985 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2986 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2989 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2990 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2991 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2992 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2993 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2994 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2997 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2999 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3000 .cindex "querying exim information"
3001 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3002 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3003 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3004 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3005 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3008 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3009 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3010 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3011 recognised DSCP names.
3013 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3014 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3015 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3016 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3017 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3018 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3019 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3020 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3021 way to guarantee a correct response.
3025 .cindex "local message reception"
3026 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3027 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3028 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3029 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3030 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3031 if no other conflicting option is present.
3033 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3034 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3035 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3036 suppressing this for special cases.
3038 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3039 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3041 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3042 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3043 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3046 .cindex "message" "format"
3047 .cindex "format" "message"
3048 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3049 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3050 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3051 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3052 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3054 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3055 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3057 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3058 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3059 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3060 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3061 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3063 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3064 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3065 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3066 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3067 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3069 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3070 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3071 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3072 .cindex "malware scan test"
3073 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3074 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3075 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3076 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3077 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3078 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3079 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3081 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3082 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3083 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3084 This option requires admin privileges.
3086 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3087 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3088 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3092 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3093 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3094 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3095 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3096 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3097 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3098 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3100 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3101 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3102 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3103 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3104 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3106 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3107 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3108 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3109 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3114 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3115 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3116 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3117 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3118 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3119 arguments, for example:
3121 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3123 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3124 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3125 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3126 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3127 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3128 users, the output is as in this example:
3130 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3132 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3133 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3135 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3136 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3137 backward compatibility.)
3138 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3139 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3141 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3142 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3143 name will not be output.
3145 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3146 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3147 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3148 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3149 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3150 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3151 written directly into the spool directory.
3153 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3155 exim -bP +local_domains
3157 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3158 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3160 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3161 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3162 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3163 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3164 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3165 that driver are output. For example:
3167 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3169 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3170 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3171 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3172 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3173 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3176 .cindex "environment"
3177 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3178 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3181 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3182 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3183 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3184 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3185 The output format is one item per line.
3186 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3187 the exit status will be nonzero.
3191 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3192 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3193 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3194 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3195 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3196 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3197 to allow any user to see the queue.
3199 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3201 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3202 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3205 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3206 .cindex "size" "of message"
3207 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3208 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3209 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3210 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3211 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3212 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3213 before the sender address.
3215 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3216 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3217 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3219 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3220 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3221 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3222 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3223 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3229 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3230 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3231 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3237 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3238 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3239 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3240 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3245 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3246 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3247 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3248 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3252 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3256 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3261 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3262 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3263 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3264 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3269 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3270 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3271 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3272 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3273 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3275 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3276 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3278 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3279 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3280 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3281 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3282 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3283 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3284 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3285 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3286 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3288 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3289 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3294 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3295 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3296 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3297 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3298 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3299 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3300 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3304 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3305 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3306 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3307 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3308 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3309 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3310 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3311 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3312 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3314 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3315 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3316 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3318 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3319 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3320 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3321 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3323 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3324 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3325 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3327 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3328 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3329 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3330 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3331 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3333 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3334 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3338 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3339 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3340 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3341 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3342 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3343 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3344 messages to the MTA.
3347 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3348 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3349 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3350 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3351 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3352 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3353 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3357 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3358 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3359 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3360 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3361 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3362 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3363 the listening daemon.
3367 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3368 .cindex "address" "testing"
3369 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3370 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3371 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3372 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3373 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3375 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3376 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3378 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3379 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3382 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3383 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3384 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3385 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3386 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3389 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3390 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3391 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3392 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3394 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3395 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3396 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3397 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3400 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3401 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3403 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3404 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3405 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3406 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3407 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3408 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3413 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3414 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3415 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3416 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3417 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3418 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3420 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3421 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3422 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3423 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3424 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3425 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3426 dynamic testing facilities.
3430 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3431 .cindex "address" "verification"
3432 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3433 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3434 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3435 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3436 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3437 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3439 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3440 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3441 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3443 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3444 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3446 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3447 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3450 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3451 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3452 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3453 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3454 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3456 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3457 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3458 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3459 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3460 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3461 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3464 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3465 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3466 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3469 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3470 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3471 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3472 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3474 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3475 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3476 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3477 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3481 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3482 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3489 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3490 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3491 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3492 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3494 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3495 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3496 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3497 each port only when the first connection is received.
3499 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3500 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3502 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3504 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3505 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3506 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3507 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3508 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3509 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3510 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3511 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3512 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3514 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3515 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3516 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3517 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3518 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3519 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3520 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3521 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3522 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3524 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3525 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3526 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3527 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3528 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3529 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3530 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3532 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3533 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3534 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3535 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3536 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3537 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3538 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3540 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3541 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3542 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3545 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3546 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3547 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3548 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3549 specified by this option.
3552 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3554 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3555 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3556 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3557 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3558 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3559 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3561 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3562 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3563 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3564 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3565 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3566 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3567 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3569 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3570 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3571 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3577 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3578 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3581 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3583 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3584 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3587 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3589 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3590 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3591 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3592 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3593 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3594 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3595 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3598 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3599 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3600 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3601 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3602 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3603 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3604 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3607 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3608 &`auth `& authenticators
3609 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3610 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3611 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3612 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3613 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3614 &`filter `& filter handling
3615 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3616 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3617 &`ident `& ident lookup
3618 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3619 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3620 &`load `& system load checks
3621 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3622 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3623 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3624 &`memory `& memory handling
3625 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3626 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3627 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3628 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3629 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3630 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3631 &`retry `& retry handling
3632 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3633 &`route `& address routing
3634 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3636 &`transport `& transports
3637 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3638 &`verify `& address verification logic
3639 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3641 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3642 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3643 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3644 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3645 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3646 turn everything off.
3648 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3649 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3650 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3651 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3652 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3655 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3656 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3657 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3658 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3659 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3662 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3663 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3666 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3667 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3668 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3669 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3670 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3671 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3673 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3674 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3676 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3678 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3679 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3680 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3681 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3684 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3685 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3686 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3687 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3691 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3692 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3693 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3694 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3695 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3696 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3697 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3698 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3701 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3702 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3703 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3704 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3705 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3707 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3709 .cindex "sender" "name"
3710 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3711 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3712 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3713 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3714 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3715 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3717 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3719 .cindex "sender" "address"
3720 .cindex "address" "sender"
3721 .cindex "trusted users"
3722 .cindex "envelope from"
3723 .cindex "envelope sender"
3724 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3725 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3726 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3727 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3730 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3731 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3732 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3733 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3736 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3737 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3738 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3739 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3740 examples of shell commands:
3742 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3743 exim -f "" user@domain
3745 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3746 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3749 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3750 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3751 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3752 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3755 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3756 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3757 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3758 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3759 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3760 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3764 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3765 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3767 control = suppress_local_fixups
3769 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3770 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3773 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3776 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3778 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3779 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3780 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3785 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3786 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3787 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3788 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3789 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3790 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3792 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3794 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3795 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3796 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3797 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3798 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3799 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3801 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3803 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3805 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3806 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3807 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3808 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3809 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3810 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3811 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3814 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3815 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3816 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3817 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3818 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3819 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3821 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3822 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3823 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3824 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3826 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3828 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3829 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3830 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3831 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3832 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3833 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3834 can be used only by an admin user.
3836 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3837 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3839 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3840 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3841 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3842 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3843 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3844 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3845 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3846 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3850 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3851 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3852 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3856 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3857 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3858 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3860 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3862 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3863 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3864 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3868 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3869 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3870 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3874 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3875 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3876 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3878 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3880 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3881 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3882 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3883 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3884 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3885 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3889 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3890 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3891 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3896 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3897 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3898 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3900 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3902 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3903 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3904 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3905 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3907 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3909 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3910 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3911 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3912 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3913 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3914 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3915 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3916 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3917 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3918 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3919 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3920 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3921 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3923 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3925 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3926 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3927 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3928 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3929 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3930 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3931 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3932 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3934 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3936 .cindex "freezing messages"
3937 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3938 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3939 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3940 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3941 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3942 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3945 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3947 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3948 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3949 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3950 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3951 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3952 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3953 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3954 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3957 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3959 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3960 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3961 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3962 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3963 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3965 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3967 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3968 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3969 .cindex "removing recipients"
3970 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3971 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3972 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3973 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3974 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3975 can be used only by an admin user.
3977 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3979 .cindex "removing messages"
3980 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3981 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3982 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3983 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3984 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3985 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3986 placed in the queue.
3991 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
3992 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
3993 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
3997 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3999 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4000 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4001 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4002 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4003 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4004 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4005 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4006 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4007 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4009 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4011 .cindex "thawing messages"
4012 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4013 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4014 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4015 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4016 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4017 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4020 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4022 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4023 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4024 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4025 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4027 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4029 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4030 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4031 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4032 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4033 only by an admin user.
4035 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4037 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4038 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4039 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4040 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4041 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4043 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4045 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4046 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4047 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4048 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4052 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4053 treats it that way too.
4057 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4058 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4059 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4060 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4061 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4062 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4063 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4066 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4067 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4068 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4069 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4070 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4071 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4072 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4077 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4078 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4079 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4080 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4082 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4084 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4087 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4089 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4090 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4091 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4094 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4096 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4097 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4098 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4099 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4100 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4101 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4105 .cindex "background delivery"
4106 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4107 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4108 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4109 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4110 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4111 processes to finish.
4113 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4114 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4115 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4116 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4118 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4119 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4120 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4121 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4125 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4126 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4127 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4128 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4129 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4130 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4132 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4133 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4136 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4137 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4139 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4140 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4141 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4142 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4147 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4152 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4153 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4154 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4155 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4156 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4157 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4158 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4159 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4160 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4161 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4166 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4167 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4168 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4169 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4170 configuration file is in effect.
4172 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4173 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4174 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4175 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4176 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4177 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4178 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4179 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4180 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4185 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4186 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4187 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4190 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4192 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4193 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4194 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4195 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4199 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4200 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4201 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4202 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4203 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4207 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4208 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4209 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4210 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4211 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4215 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4216 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4221 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4222 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4227 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4228 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4229 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4230 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4231 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4232 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4235 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4236 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4238 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4240 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4241 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4242 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4243 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4244 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4245 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4247 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4248 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4250 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4252 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4253 followed by a colon and the port number:
4255 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4257 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4258 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4259 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4260 whichever one is last.
4262 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4264 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4265 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4266 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4267 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4268 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4269 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4271 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4273 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4274 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4275 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4276 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4277 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4278 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4280 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4282 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4283 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4284 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4285 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4286 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4287 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4288 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4289 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4291 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4293 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4294 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4295 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4296 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4297 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4299 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4301 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4302 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4303 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4304 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4305 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4306 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4307 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4309 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4310 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4311 is sending the bounce.
4313 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4315 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4316 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4317 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4318 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4319 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4320 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4321 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4322 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4323 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4324 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4326 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4328 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4329 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4330 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4331 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4332 uses the name it is given.
4334 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4336 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4337 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4338 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4339 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4340 used, when there is no default.
4344 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4345 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4346 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4347 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4351 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4352 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4353 whatever that means.
4355 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4357 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4358 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4359 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4360 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4361 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4362 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4363 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4365 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4367 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4368 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4369 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4370 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4371 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4373 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4375 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4376 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4377 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4378 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4379 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4380 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4384 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4386 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4388 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4389 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4390 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4391 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4392 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4393 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4394 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4395 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4399 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4400 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4401 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4402 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4407 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4408 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4409 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4410 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4413 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4415 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4417 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4419 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4420 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4421 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4422 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4423 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4424 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4428 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4429 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4430 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4431 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4432 and &%-S%& options).
4434 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4435 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4436 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4437 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4438 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4439 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4440 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4443 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4444 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4445 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4446 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4447 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4450 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4451 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4452 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4453 this to be repeated periodically.
4455 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4456 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4457 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4458 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4460 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4461 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4462 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4464 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4465 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4466 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4467 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4471 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4472 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4473 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4474 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4475 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4476 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4479 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4480 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4481 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4482 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4483 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4484 delivered down a single SMTP
4485 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4486 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4487 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4488 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4489 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4492 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4494 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4495 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4496 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4497 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4498 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4500 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4502 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4503 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4504 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4505 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4506 their retry times are tried.
4508 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4510 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4511 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4514 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4516 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4517 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4518 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4521 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4524 .cindex "named queues"
4525 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4526 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4527 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4528 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4529 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4530 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4532 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4533 will specify a queue to operate on.
4536 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4538 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4541 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4542 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4543 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4544 starting message id. For example:
4546 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4548 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4549 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4550 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4552 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4554 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4555 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4556 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4557 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4558 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4559 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4561 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4562 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4563 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4564 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4565 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4566 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4567 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4568 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4569 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4571 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4573 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4574 process every 30 minutes.
4576 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4577 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4579 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4581 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4584 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4586 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4588 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4590 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4591 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4592 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4593 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4594 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4595 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4596 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4598 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4599 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4600 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4601 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4602 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4603 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4605 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4606 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4608 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4610 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4611 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4612 applied to each queue run.
4614 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4615 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4616 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4617 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4618 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4619 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4620 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4621 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4622 address will be skipped.
4624 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4625 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4626 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4629 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4630 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4631 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4632 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4633 an arbitrary command instead.
4637 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4639 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4641 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4642 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4643 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4644 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4645 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4646 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4648 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4650 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4651 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4652 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4656 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4657 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4658 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4659 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4660 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4661 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4662 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4663 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4664 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4666 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4667 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4668 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4669 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4670 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4671 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4672 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4673 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4674 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4675 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4676 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4678 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4679 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4680 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4681 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4682 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4683 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4685 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4686 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4687 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4688 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4689 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4690 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4691 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4692 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4693 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4697 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4698 compatibility with Sendmail.
4700 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4701 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4702 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4703 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4704 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4705 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4706 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4707 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4712 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4713 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4714 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4715 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4716 set. Exim ignores this option.
4720 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4721 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4722 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4723 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4724 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4725 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4730 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4731 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4732 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4735 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4737 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4738 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4740 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4742 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4743 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4744 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4752 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4753 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4754 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4755 . creates a man page for the options.
4756 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4759 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4766 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4767 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4770 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4771 "The runtime configuration file"
4773 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4774 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4775 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4776 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4777 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4778 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4779 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4780 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4781 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4784 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4785 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4786 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4787 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4788 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4789 actually alter the string.
4791 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4792 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4793 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4794 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4795 existing file in the list.
4798 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4799 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4800 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4801 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4802 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4803 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4804 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4805 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4806 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4807 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4809 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4810 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4811 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4812 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4813 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4815 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4816 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4817 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4818 compromise the Exim user account.
4820 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4821 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4822 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4823 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4824 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4825 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4830 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4831 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4832 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4833 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4834 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4835 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4836 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4837 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4838 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4839 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4840 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4842 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4843 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4844 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4845 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4846 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4847 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4848 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4849 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4850 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4853 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4854 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4855 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4856 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4857 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4859 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4860 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4861 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4862 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4863 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4864 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4866 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4867 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4868 necessarily be discarded.
4869 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4870 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4871 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4872 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4873 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4874 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4876 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4877 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4878 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4879 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4880 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4881 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4882 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4884 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4885 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4886 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4890 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4891 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4892 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4893 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4894 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4895 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4896 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4897 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4900 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4903 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4904 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4905 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4907 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4908 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4909 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4911 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4912 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4913 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4915 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4916 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4917 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4918 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4921 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4922 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4923 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4925 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4926 want to use this feature, you must set
4928 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4930 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4931 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4934 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4935 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4936 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4937 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4939 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4940 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4941 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4942 and does not introduce a comment.
4944 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4945 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4946 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4947 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4948 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4950 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4951 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4952 change settings as required.
4954 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4955 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4956 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4957 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4958 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4963 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4964 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4965 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4966 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4967 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4968 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
4971 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
4972 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
4974 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
4975 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4976 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4977 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4978 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
4981 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4982 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4983 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4984 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4986 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4987 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4990 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4993 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4994 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4999 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5000 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5001 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5002 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5003 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5004 definition, and must be of the form
5006 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5008 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5009 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5010 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5011 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5012 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5014 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5015 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5016 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5018 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5019 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5020 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5021 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5022 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5023 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5024 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5027 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5028 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5030 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5031 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5032 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5033 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5034 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5035 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5038 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5039 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5040 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5045 MAC == updated value
5047 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5048 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5049 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5050 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5054 MAC == MAC and something added
5056 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5057 from a number of other files.
5059 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5060 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5061 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5062 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5063 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5068 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5069 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5070 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5071 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5073 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5074 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5076 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5078 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5080 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5081 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5082 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5085 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5086 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5087 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5088 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5089 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5092 The following classes of macros are defined:
5094 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5095 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5096 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5097 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5098 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5099 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5100 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5101 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5102 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5103 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5104 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5105 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5108 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5111 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5112 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5113 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5114 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5115 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5116 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5117 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5119 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5120 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5121 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5125 message_size_limit = 50M
5127 message_size_limit = 100M
5130 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5131 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5132 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5133 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5134 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5136 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5137 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5138 in this line"& will always be true.
5140 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5141 to clarify complicated nestings.
5145 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5146 .cindex "common option syntax"
5147 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5148 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5149 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5150 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5151 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5152 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5153 space) and then the value. For example:
5155 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5157 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5158 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5159 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5160 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5161 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5162 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5163 word &"hide"&. For example:
5165 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5167 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5169 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5171 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5172 all instances of the same driver.
5174 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5175 that are found in option settings.
5178 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5179 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5180 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5181 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5182 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5183 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5184 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5185 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5186 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5187 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5188 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5189 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5194 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5199 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5204 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5205 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5206 .cindex "format" "integer"
5207 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5208 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5209 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5210 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5213 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5214 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5215 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5217 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5218 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5219 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5223 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5224 .cindex "integer format"
5225 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5226 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5227 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5228 Such options are always output in octal.
5231 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5232 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5233 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5234 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5235 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5239 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5240 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5241 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5242 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5243 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5253 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5254 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5255 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5259 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5260 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5261 .cindex "format" "string"
5262 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5263 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5264 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5265 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5266 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5267 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5268 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5269 therefore equivalent:
5271 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5272 trusted_users = uucp:\
5273 # This comment line is ignored
5276 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5277 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5278 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5279 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5280 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5283 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5284 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5285 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5287 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5288 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5292 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5293 character, that character replaces the pair.
5295 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5296 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5297 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5298 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5299 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5300 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5303 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5304 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5305 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5306 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5307 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5308 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5309 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5310 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5311 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5312 within a quoted configuration string.
5315 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5316 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5317 .cindex "format" "user name"
5318 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5319 .cindex "format" "group name"
5320 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5321 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5322 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5323 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5326 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5327 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5328 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5329 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5330 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5331 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5332 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5333 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5334 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5335 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5336 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5338 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5339 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5340 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5341 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5342 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5343 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5346 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5348 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5350 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5351 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5352 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5353 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5355 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5356 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5357 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5358 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5359 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5360 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5361 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5362 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5364 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5366 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5367 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5368 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5370 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5371 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5372 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5373 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5374 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5375 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5376 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5377 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5378 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5380 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5382 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5383 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5384 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5385 the value in quotes. For example:
5387 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5389 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5390 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5391 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5392 enclosing an empty list item.
5396 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5397 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5398 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5399 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5401 senders = user@domain :
5403 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5404 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5405 items, the second of which is empty:
5407 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5409 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5410 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5411 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5412 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5416 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5417 is at the end of the list.
5422 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5423 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5424 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5425 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5426 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5427 a sequence of lines like this:
5429 <&'instance name'&>:
5434 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5435 followed by three options settings:
5440 transport = local_delivery
5442 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5443 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5444 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5445 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5446 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5447 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5449 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5450 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5452 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5453 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5454 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5455 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5456 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5459 .cindex "generic options"
5460 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5461 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5462 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5463 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5464 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5465 .cindex "private options"
5466 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5467 they all have default values.
5469 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5470 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5471 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5473 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5474 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5475 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5476 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5477 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5478 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5479 configuration lines:
5484 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5485 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5486 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5487 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5493 command_timeout = 10s
5495 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5496 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5499 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5500 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5501 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5509 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5510 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5512 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5513 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5514 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5515 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5516 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5517 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5518 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5519 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5520 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5521 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5522 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5526 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5527 All macros should be defined before any options.
5529 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5531 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5533 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5534 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5535 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5536 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5538 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5539 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5540 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5543 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5544 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5545 in the file, after the macros.
5546 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5548 # primary_hostname =
5550 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5551 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5552 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5553 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5555 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5557 domainlist local_domains = @
5558 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5559 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5561 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5562 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5563 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5564 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5566 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5567 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5570 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5571 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5572 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5573 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5574 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5575 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5577 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5578 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5579 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5580 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5581 domain is permitted.
5583 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5584 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5585 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5586 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5587 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5588 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5590 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5591 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5592 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5594 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5596 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5597 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5599 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5600 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5601 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5602 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5603 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5604 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5605 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5606 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5607 contents of a message to be checked.
5609 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5611 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5612 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5614 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5615 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5616 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5617 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5619 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5621 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5622 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5623 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5625 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5626 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5627 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5628 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5629 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5630 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5631 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5633 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5635 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5636 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5638 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5639 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5640 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5641 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5642 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5643 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5644 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5645 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5646 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5647 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5648 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5649 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5650 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5651 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5652 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5653 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5655 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5656 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5657 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5658 which should be used in preference to 587.
5659 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5661 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5663 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5666 # qualify_recipient =
5668 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5669 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5670 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5671 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5672 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5673 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5675 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5676 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5677 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5678 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5680 # allow_domain_literals
5682 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5683 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5684 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5685 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5686 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5687 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5689 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5693 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5694 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5695 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5696 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5697 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5698 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5699 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5700 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5702 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5703 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5708 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5709 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5710 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5711 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5712 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5713 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5716 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5717 1413 (hence their names):
5720 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5722 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5723 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5724 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5725 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5726 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5727 information, you can change this.
5729 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5730 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5735 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5736 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5737 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5738 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5740 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5741 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5743 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5744 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5746 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5749 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5750 +tls_certificate_verified
5753 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5755 # percent_hack_domains =
5757 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5758 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5759 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5761 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5762 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5763 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5764 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5765 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5766 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5767 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5768 always bounce messages.
5770 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5771 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5773 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5774 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5775 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5776 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5777 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5779 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5780 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5781 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5782 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5783 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5786 # split_spool_directory = true
5789 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5790 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5791 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5792 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5793 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5794 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5795 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5797 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5800 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5801 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5802 that are not 8-bit clean.
5804 # accept_8bitmime = false
5807 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5808 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5809 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5810 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5811 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5812 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5814 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5815 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5819 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5820 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5821 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5822 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5823 It starts with the line
5827 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5828 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5829 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5831 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5832 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5833 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5834 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5835 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5836 result of the ACL processing.
5840 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5845 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5846 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5847 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5848 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5849 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5850 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5852 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5853 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5854 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5857 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5858 domains = +local_domains
5859 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5861 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5862 domains = !+local_domains
5863 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5865 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5866 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5867 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5868 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5869 in Internet mail addresses.
5871 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5872 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5873 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5874 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5875 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5876 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5877 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5878 policy of being as safe as possible.
5880 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5881 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5882 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5883 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5884 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5885 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5887 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5888 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5889 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5890 have to modify this rule.
5892 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5893 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5894 common convention of local parts constructed as
5895 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5896 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5897 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5898 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5899 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5900 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5902 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5903 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5904 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5905 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5906 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5907 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5908 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5910 accept local_parts = postmaster
5911 domains = +local_domains
5913 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5914 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5915 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5916 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5917 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5919 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5920 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5921 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5923 require verify = sender
5925 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5926 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5927 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5928 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5929 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5930 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5931 discusses the details of address verification.
5933 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5934 control = submission
5936 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5937 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5938 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5939 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5940 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5941 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5942 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5943 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5944 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5946 accept authenticated = *
5947 control = submission
5949 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5950 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5951 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5952 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5953 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5954 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5956 require message = relay not permitted
5957 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5959 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5960 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5962 require verify = recipient
5964 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5965 fails, the address is rejected.
5967 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5968 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5970 # dnslists = black.list.example
5972 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5973 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5974 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5975 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5977 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5978 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5979 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5982 # require verify = csa
5984 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5985 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5990 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5991 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5995 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5996 of this ACL are commented out:
5999 # message = This message contains a virus \
6002 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6003 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6004 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6005 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6007 # warn spam = nobody
6008 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6009 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6010 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6011 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6013 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6014 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6015 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6016 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6017 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6018 whatever the spam score.
6022 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6025 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6026 .cindex "default" "routers"
6027 .cindex "routers" "default"
6028 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6033 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6034 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6035 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6036 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6037 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6040 # driver = ipliteral
6041 # domains = !+local_domains
6042 # transport = remote_smtp
6044 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6045 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6046 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6047 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6048 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6050 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6051 macro has been defined, per
6053 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6062 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6063 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6064 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6065 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6069 driver = manualroute
6070 domains = ! +local_domains
6071 transport = smarthost_smtp
6072 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6073 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6076 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6077 specified by the line
6079 domains = ! +local_domains
6081 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6082 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6083 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6084 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6085 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6086 passed on to the following routers.
6088 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6089 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6090 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6091 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6093 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6094 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6095 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6096 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6097 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6098 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6099 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6104 domains = ! +local_domains
6105 transport = remote_smtp
6106 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6109 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6111 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6112 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6113 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6114 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6115 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6117 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6118 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6119 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6120 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6121 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6122 the address fails and is bounced.
6124 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6125 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6126 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6127 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6128 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6129 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6130 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6137 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6139 file_transport = address_file
6140 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6142 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6143 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6144 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6145 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6146 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6149 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6150 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6151 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6152 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6157 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6158 # local_part_suffix_optional
6159 file = $home/.forward
6164 file_transport = address_file
6165 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6166 reply_transport = address_reply
6168 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6169 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6170 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6171 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6172 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6175 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6176 # local_part_suffix_optional
6178 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6179 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6180 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6181 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6182 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6183 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6184 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6186 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6187 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6188 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6189 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6191 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6192 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6193 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6194 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6195 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6196 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6197 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6199 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6200 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6201 There are two reasons for doing this:
6204 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6205 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6208 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6209 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6210 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6211 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6215 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6216 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6217 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6218 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6220 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6221 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6222 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6224 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6226 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6232 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6233 # local_part_suffix_optional
6234 transport = local_delivery
6236 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6237 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6238 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6239 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6240 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6243 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6244 .cindex "default" "transports"
6245 .cindex "transports" "default"
6246 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6247 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6248 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6252 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6256 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6258 dnssec_request_domains = *
6265 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6266 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6267 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6268 with over-long lines. The built-in macro _HAVE_DANE guards configuration
6269 to try to use DNSSEC for all queries and to use DANE for delivery;
6270 see section &<<SECDANE>>& for more details.
6272 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6273 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6274 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6275 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6277 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6278 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6279 usual federated system.
6284 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6288 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6289 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6290 hosts_require_tls = *
6291 tls_verify_hosts = *
6292 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6293 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6295 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6297 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6298 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6299 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6300 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6301 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6302 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6304 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6305 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6308 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6315 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6316 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6317 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6318 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6319 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6320 then no other options are defined.
6321 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6322 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6323 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6324 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6325 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6326 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6327 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6328 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6329 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6330 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6331 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6333 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6335 All other options are defaulted.
6339 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6346 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6347 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6348 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6349 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6350 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6351 show how this can be done.
6353 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6354 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6355 similarly-named options above.
6361 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6362 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6363 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6364 be returned to the sender.
6372 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6373 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6374 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6379 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6384 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6385 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6386 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6387 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6388 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6389 introduced by the line
6393 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6396 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6398 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6399 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6400 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6401 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6402 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6404 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6405 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6406 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6409 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6410 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6414 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6415 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6419 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6420 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6421 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6423 begin authenticators
6425 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6426 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6427 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6428 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6429 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6430 to support most MUA software.
6432 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6435 # driver = plaintext
6436 # server_set_id = $auth2
6437 # server_prompts = :
6438 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6439 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6441 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6444 # driver = plaintext
6445 # server_set_id = $auth1
6446 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6447 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6448 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6451 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6452 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6453 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6454 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6455 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6456 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6457 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6458 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6460 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6461 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6462 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6463 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6465 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6466 usercode and password are in different positions.
6467 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6469 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6473 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6474 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6476 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6478 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6480 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6481 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6482 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6483 regular expressions is discussed in
6484 online Perl manpages, in
6485 many Perl reference books, and also in
6486 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6487 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6488 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6489 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6490 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6492 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6493 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6494 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6495 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6496 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6499 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6500 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6501 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6502 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6504 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6506 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6507 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6508 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6509 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6510 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6511 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6514 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6515 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6516 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6517 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6518 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6519 match anywhere in the subject string.
6521 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6522 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6524 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6526 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6529 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6531 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6532 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6536 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6537 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6539 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6540 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6541 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6542 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6543 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6544 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6547 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6548 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6549 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6550 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6551 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6552 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6554 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6555 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6556 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6557 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6558 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6559 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6562 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6563 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6564 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6565 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6566 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6567 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6569 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6570 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6571 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6572 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6573 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6575 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6576 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6578 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6579 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6580 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6581 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6582 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6584 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6585 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6587 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6588 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6590 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6591 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6592 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6597 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6598 matches the list item.
6600 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6601 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6603 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6605 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6606 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6607 causes a second lookup to occur.
6609 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6610 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6611 lookup is permitted.
6614 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6615 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6616 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6617 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6620 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6621 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6622 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6624 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6625 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6626 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6627 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6630 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6631 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6632 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6637 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6638 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6639 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6644 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6645 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6646 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6647 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6650 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6651 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6652 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6653 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6654 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6655 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6656 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6657 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6658 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6660 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6661 &url(http://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6662 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6663 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6665 . --- 2018-09-07: corpit.ru http:-only
6666 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6667 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6668 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6669 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6671 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6672 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6673 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6674 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6675 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6676 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6677 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6679 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6680 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6681 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6682 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6683 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6684 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6685 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6687 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6688 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6690 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6691 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6692 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6693 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6694 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6695 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6696 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6698 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6699 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6700 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6702 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6703 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6704 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6705 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6706 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6707 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6708 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6709 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6710 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6711 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6713 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6714 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6715 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6716 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6717 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6718 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6719 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6720 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6721 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6723 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6724 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6725 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6726 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6727 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6728 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6729 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6731 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6732 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6733 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6734 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6736 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6737 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6738 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6739 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6740 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6742 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6743 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6744 lookup types support only literal keys.
6746 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6747 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6748 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6751 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6752 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6753 notation before executing the lookup.)
6758 .cindex json "lookup type"
6759 .cindex JSON expansions
6760 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6761 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6762 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6763 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6764 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6765 of the JSON structure.
6766 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6767 nunbered array element is selected.
6768 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6769 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6770 or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6772 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6775 .cindex "linear search"
6776 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6777 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6778 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6779 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6780 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6781 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6782 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6783 in the file is used.
6785 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6786 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6787 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6788 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6789 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6794 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6795 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6796 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6797 wildcarding of any kind.
6799 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6800 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6801 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6802 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6803 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6804 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6805 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6806 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6807 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6810 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6811 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6812 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6813 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6814 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6815 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6816 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6817 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6820 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6821 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6822 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6823 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6824 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6825 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6826 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6827 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6828 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6830 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6831 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6832 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6833 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6835 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6836 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6839 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6841 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6842 *fish data for anythingfish
6845 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6846 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6848 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6850 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6851 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6852 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6854 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6856 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6857 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6858 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6860 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6863 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6864 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6865 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6866 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6867 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6869 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6870 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6871 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6872 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6873 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6876 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6877 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6878 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6881 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6883 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6886 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6887 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6888 be followed by optional colons.
6890 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6891 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6892 lookup types support only literal keys.
6895 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6896 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6897 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6898 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6902 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6903 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6904 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6905 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6906 many of them are given in later sections.
6909 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6910 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6911 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6912 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6913 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6915 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6916 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6917 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6919 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6920 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6921 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6922 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6923 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6924 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6925 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6927 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6928 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6929 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6930 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6932 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6933 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6934 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6935 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6937 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6938 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6939 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6940 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6942 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6943 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6944 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6945 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6946 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6947 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6948 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6949 password value. For example:
6951 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6954 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6955 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6956 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6957 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6960 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6961 .cindex lookup Redis
6962 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6963 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6966 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6967 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6968 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6969 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6972 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6973 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6975 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6976 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6977 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6978 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6979 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6980 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6981 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6982 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6983 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6984 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6986 require condition = \
6987 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6989 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6990 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6991 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6992 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6997 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6998 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6999 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7000 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7001 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7002 options such as a list of local domains.
7004 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7005 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7006 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7007 or may give up altogether.
7011 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7012 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7013 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7014 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7015 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7016 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7017 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7018 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7020 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7021 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7022 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7024 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7025 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7026 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7028 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7029 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7030 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7031 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7032 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7033 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7034 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7035 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7036 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7037 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7039 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7041 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7042 looks up these keys, in this order:
7048 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7049 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7050 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7051 Exim move on to try the next key.
7055 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7056 .cindex "partial matching"
7057 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7058 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7059 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7060 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7061 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7062 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7063 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7064 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7065 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7066 a key in a DBM file is
7068 *.dates.fict.example
7070 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7071 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7072 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7075 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7076 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7077 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7079 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7080 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7081 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7082 partial matching keys
7083 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7084 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7085 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7087 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7088 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7089 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7090 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7091 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7092 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7095 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7096 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7097 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7098 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7099 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7100 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7102 2250.dates.fict.example
7103 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7104 *.dates.fict.example
7107 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7110 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7111 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7112 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7113 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7114 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7115 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7117 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7119 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7120 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7121 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7122 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7124 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7126 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7127 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7129 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7130 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7131 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7134 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7136 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7137 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7139 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7140 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7141 for &"*"& on its own.
7143 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7147 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7148 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7149 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7150 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7151 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7152 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7153 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7155 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7156 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7157 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7158 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7159 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7164 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7165 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7166 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7167 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7168 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7169 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7170 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7172 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7173 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7174 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7175 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7176 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7177 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7179 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7180 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7186 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7187 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7188 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7189 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7190 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7191 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7195 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7196 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7198 [name="$local_part"]
7200 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7201 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7202 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7203 of the following form is provided:
7205 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7207 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7209 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7211 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7212 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7213 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7218 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7219 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7220 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7221 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7222 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7223 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7224 an expansion string could contain:
7226 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7228 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7229 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7230 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7231 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7233 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7234 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7235 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7237 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7238 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7239 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7240 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7241 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7243 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7245 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7246 white space is ignored.
7247 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7248 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7249 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7251 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7252 When the type is PTR,
7253 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7254 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7256 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7258 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7259 altered and nothing is added.
7261 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7262 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7263 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7264 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7265 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7266 The field separator can be modified as above.
7268 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7269 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7270 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7271 unless a field separator is specified.
7272 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7274 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7276 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7277 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7278 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7280 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7281 white space is ignored.
7283 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7284 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7285 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7286 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7289 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7292 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7293 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7294 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7295 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7296 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7297 each followed by a comma,
7298 that may appear before the record type.
7300 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7301 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7302 a defer-option modifier.
7303 The possible keywords are
7304 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7305 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7306 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7307 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7308 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7309 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7310 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7312 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7313 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7315 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7316 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7318 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7319 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7320 The possible keywords are
7321 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7322 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7324 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7325 is not labelled as authenticated data
7326 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7327 The default is &"never"&.
7329 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7331 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7332 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7333 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7334 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7336 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7338 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7339 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7340 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7342 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7343 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7345 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7346 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7347 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7350 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7351 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7352 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7353 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7354 the pseudo-type MXH:
7356 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7358 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7361 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7362 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7363 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7364 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7365 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7366 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7367 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7368 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7370 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7371 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7373 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7374 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7375 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7377 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7378 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7379 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7380 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7381 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7384 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7385 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7386 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7387 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7388 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7389 result of a successful lookup such as:
7391 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7393 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7394 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7395 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7397 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7398 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7399 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7400 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7402 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7406 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7407 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7408 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7409 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7410 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7412 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7413 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7414 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7416 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7417 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7418 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7419 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7421 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7422 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7423 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7428 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7429 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7430 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7431 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7432 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7433 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7434 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7435 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7436 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7437 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7438 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7439 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7441 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7442 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7443 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7444 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7445 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7447 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7448 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7450 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7451 the way they handle the results of a query:
7454 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7457 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7458 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7460 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7461 from all of them are returned.
7465 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7466 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7467 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7468 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7471 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7472 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7473 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7474 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7476 data = ${lookup ldap \
7477 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7478 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7480 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7481 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7482 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7483 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7485 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7486 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7487 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7489 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7490 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7491 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7492 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7493 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7494 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7495 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7496 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7500 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7501 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7502 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7503 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7504 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7505 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7507 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7508 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7516 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7517 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7521 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7523 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7527 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7529 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7531 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7533 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7534 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7535 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7539 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7540 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7541 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7543 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7547 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7549 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7551 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7553 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7554 authentication below.
7557 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7558 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7559 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7560 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7561 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7564 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7566 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7567 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7568 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7569 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7570 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7571 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7572 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7573 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7574 failures, and timeouts.
7576 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7577 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7578 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7579 doubled. For example
7581 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7583 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7584 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7585 the local host) is used.
7587 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7588 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7589 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7590 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7593 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7594 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7595 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7596 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7598 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7600 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7601 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7603 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7605 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7606 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7607 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7608 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7609 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7610 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7611 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7614 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7615 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7616 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7619 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7622 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7626 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7627 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7631 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7632 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7633 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7634 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7635 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7636 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7637 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7638 them. The following names are recognized:
7640 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7641 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7642 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7643 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7644 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7645 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7646 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7647 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7649 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7650 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7651 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7652 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7654 .cindex LDAP timeout
7655 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7656 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7657 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7658 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7659 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7660 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7661 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7662 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7663 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7664 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7666 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7667 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7669 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7670 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7671 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7672 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7673 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7674 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7675 alternate list (colon-separated).
7677 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7678 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7681 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7682 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7685 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7686 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7687 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7688 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7690 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7691 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7692 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7694 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7695 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7696 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7697 quoting has two advantages:
7700 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7701 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7703 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7706 For example, a setting such as
7708 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7710 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7712 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7713 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7714 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7715 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7719 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7720 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7725 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7726 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7727 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7728 as a sequence of values, for example
7730 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7732 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7733 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7734 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7735 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7736 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7739 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7740 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7741 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7742 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7744 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7745 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7746 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7747 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7748 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7749 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7750 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7751 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7752 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7754 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7755 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7756 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7757 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7758 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7761 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7764 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7767 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7768 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7770 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7771 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7773 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7774 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7777 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7778 results of LDAP lookups.
7779 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7780 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7781 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7782 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7783 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7784 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7789 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7790 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7791 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7792 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7793 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7794 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7795 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7796 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7798 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7800 might return the string
7802 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7803 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7805 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7807 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7813 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7814 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7815 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7819 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7820 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7821 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7822 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7823 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7824 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7825 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7826 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7827 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7828 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7829 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7830 .cindex lookup Redis
7831 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7833 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7836 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7839 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7840 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7842 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7847 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7849 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7850 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7851 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7855 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7856 with a newline between the data for each row.
7859 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7860 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7861 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7862 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7863 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7864 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7865 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7866 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7867 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7868 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7869 .cindex lookup Redis
7870 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7871 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7872 or &%redis_servers%&
7873 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7875 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7876 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7877 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7879 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7880 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7881 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7882 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7884 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7886 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7887 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7888 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7890 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7891 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7893 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7894 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7895 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7896 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7897 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7898 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7900 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7901 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7902 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7904 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7905 host, database number, and password.
7907 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7908 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7909 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7911 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7913 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7916 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7917 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7918 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7919 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7921 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7922 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7924 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7925 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7926 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7927 done by starting the query with
7929 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7931 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7933 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7934 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7935 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7938 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7940 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7941 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7942 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7944 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7945 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7946 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7949 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7953 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7955 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7957 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7958 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7959 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7961 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7965 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7966 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7967 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7968 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7969 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7970 the default value is &"exim"&.
7971 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7973 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7974 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7976 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7977 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7979 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7982 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7983 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7985 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7986 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7987 is zero because no rows are affected.
7990 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7991 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7992 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7993 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7994 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7997 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7999 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8000 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8001 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8003 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8004 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8007 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8008 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8009 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8010 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8011 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8012 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8013 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8014 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8015 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8017 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8018 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8020 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8022 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8023 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8025 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8026 quote, which it doubles.
8028 .cindex timeout SQLite
8029 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8030 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8031 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8032 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8033 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8034 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8035 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8038 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8039 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8040 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8041 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8044 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8045 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8048 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8049 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8050 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8051 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8054 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8055 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8056 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8063 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8064 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8066 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8067 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8068 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8069 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8070 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8071 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8072 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8073 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8074 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8076 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8077 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8078 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8079 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8081 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8082 support all the complexity available in
8083 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8087 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8088 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8089 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8091 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8092 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8095 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8096 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8097 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8098 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8099 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8102 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8103 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8104 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8106 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8107 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8108 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8109 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8110 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8112 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8113 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8115 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8116 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8117 senders based on the receiving domain.
8122 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8123 .cindex "list" "negation"
8124 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8125 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8126 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8127 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8128 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8129 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8131 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8132 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8133 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8134 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8135 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8137 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8139 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8140 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8141 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8143 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8145 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8146 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8147 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8149 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8150 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8155 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8156 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8157 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8158 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8159 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8160 filenames are not allowed,
8161 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8162 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8166 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8167 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8169 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8170 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8171 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8173 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8177 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8178 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8179 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8180 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8182 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8183 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8185 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8187 and the file contains the lines
8192 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8193 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8197 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8198 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8199 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8200 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8201 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8202 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8203 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8204 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8206 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8207 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8208 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8209 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8214 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8215 .cindex "named lists"
8216 .cindex "list" "named"
8217 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8218 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8219 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8220 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8221 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8222 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8223 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8225 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8227 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8228 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8229 configured with the line
8231 domains = +local_domains
8233 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8234 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8238 domains = ! +local_domains
8239 transport = remote_smtp
8242 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8243 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8244 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8245 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8247 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8248 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8250 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8252 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8253 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8254 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8256 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8257 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8258 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8260 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8261 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8263 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8264 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8265 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8267 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8269 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8270 referenced lists if you can.
8272 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8273 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8274 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8276 domains = +local_domains
8278 on several of your routers
8279 or in several ACL statements,
8280 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8281 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8282 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8283 the same each time they are referenced.
8285 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8286 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8287 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8288 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8292 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8293 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8294 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8295 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8296 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8299 ALIST = host1 : host2
8300 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8302 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8304 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8306 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8309 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8310 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8312 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8314 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8318 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8319 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8320 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8321 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8322 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8323 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8324 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8325 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8326 message. For example:
8328 domainlist special_domains = \
8329 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8331 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8332 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8333 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8334 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8335 same list each time.
8337 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8338 cache the result anyway. For example:
8340 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8342 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8343 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8347 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8348 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8349 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8350 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8351 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8354 .cindex "primary host name"
8355 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8356 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8357 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8358 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8359 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8360 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8361 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8362 differ only in their names.
8364 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8365 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8366 .cindex "domain literal"
8367 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8368 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8369 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8370 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8371 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8372 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8375 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8376 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8377 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8378 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8379 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8380 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8381 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8382 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8383 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8384 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8385 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8387 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8388 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8389 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8390 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8391 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8393 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8394 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8395 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8396 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8397 on a router). For example:
8399 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8401 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8402 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8404 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8405 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8406 contain negative items.
8408 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8409 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8410 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8412 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8413 an.other.domain : ...
8415 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8416 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8418 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8419 an.other.domain ? ...
8422 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8423 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8424 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8425 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8426 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8427 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8428 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8429 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8430 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8434 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8435 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8436 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8437 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8438 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8439 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8440 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8441 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8442 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8444 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8445 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8446 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8447 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8448 expression by expansion, of course).
8450 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8451 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8452 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8453 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8454 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8455 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8457 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8459 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8460 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8461 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8462 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8463 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8464 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8465 other statements in the same ACL.
8468 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8469 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8471 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8473 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8474 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8477 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8478 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8479 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8480 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8481 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8482 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8485 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8486 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8487 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8488 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8490 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8491 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8493 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8494 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8495 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8496 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8497 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8499 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8500 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8501 between the pattern and the domain.
8504 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8506 domainlist funny_domains = \
8509 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8510 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8511 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8512 nis;domains.byname : \
8513 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8515 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8516 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8517 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8518 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8519 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8524 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8525 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8526 .cindex "list" "host list"
8527 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8528 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8529 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8530 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8531 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8532 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8533 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8536 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8537 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8538 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8539 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8540 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8541 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8544 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8545 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8546 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8550 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8551 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8552 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8553 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8554 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8555 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8556 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8559 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8560 inspecting its IP address:
8563 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8564 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8565 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8566 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8567 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8568 with the IP address of the subject host.
8570 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8571 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8572 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8573 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8574 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8577 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8578 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8579 domain name, as just described.
8582 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8583 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8584 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8585 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8586 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8587 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8588 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8589 that can never match a client host.
8592 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8593 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8594 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8595 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8597 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8601 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8602 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8603 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8604 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8605 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8606 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8607 significant end of the address.
8609 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8610 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8611 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8612 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8616 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8617 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8620 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8622 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8623 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8625 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8626 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8629 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8631 could make use of a file containing
8636 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8637 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8638 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8640 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8643 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8649 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8650 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8651 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8652 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8653 address, the pattern takes this form:
8655 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8659 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8661 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8662 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8663 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8664 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8665 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8666 returned by the lookup is not used.
8668 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8669 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8670 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8671 patterns of this form:
8673 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8677 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8679 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8680 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8681 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8682 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8683 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8685 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8686 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8687 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8688 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8689 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8690 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8691 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8692 converted using colons and not dots.
8694 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8695 addresses are always used.
8696 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8699 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8700 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8701 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8704 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8705 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8706 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8707 case the IP address is used on its own.
8711 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8712 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8713 .cindex "unknown host name"
8714 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8715 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8716 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8717 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8718 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8721 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8722 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8723 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8724 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8725 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8726 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8727 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8729 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8730 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8732 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8733 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8734 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8735 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8736 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8737 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8738 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8739 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8740 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8742 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8743 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8745 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8746 .cindex "alias for host"
8747 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8748 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8751 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8752 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8753 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8754 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8755 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8758 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8759 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8760 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8761 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8762 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8763 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8764 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8769 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8770 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8771 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8772 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8773 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8775 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8777 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8778 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8779 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8786 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8787 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8788 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8789 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8790 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8791 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8793 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8794 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8796 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8797 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8798 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8799 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8800 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8801 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8802 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8803 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8804 not recognized in an indirected file).
8807 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8808 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8810 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8812 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8813 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8816 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8817 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8820 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8823 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8824 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8825 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8828 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8829 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8832 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8834 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8836 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8837 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8838 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8841 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8842 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8843 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8845 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8847 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8848 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8849 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8850 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8851 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8852 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8853 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8856 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8857 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8859 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8860 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8862 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8863 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8864 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8869 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8871 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8872 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8873 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8874 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8875 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8876 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8877 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8878 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8879 host lists such as whitelists.
8883 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8884 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8885 .cindex "unknown host name"
8886 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8887 If a pattern is of the form
8889 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8893 dbm;/host/accept/list
8895 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8896 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8899 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8900 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8901 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8902 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8903 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8904 lookup, both using the same file.
8908 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8909 If a pattern is of the form
8911 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8913 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8914 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8915 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8917 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8918 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8920 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8921 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8922 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8925 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8926 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8927 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8929 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8930 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8931 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8932 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8933 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8934 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8940 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8941 .cindex "list" "address list"
8942 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8943 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8944 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8945 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8946 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8947 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8948 using this option setting:
8952 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8953 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8954 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8955 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8957 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8960 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8962 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8963 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8964 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8965 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8966 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8967 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8968 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8970 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8971 *@+hostile_domains:\
8972 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8973 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8975 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8976 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8977 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8978 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8979 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8981 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8982 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8983 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8984 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8985 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8987 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8990 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8991 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8995 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8996 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8997 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8998 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8999 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9000 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9001 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9003 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9004 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9006 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9007 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9010 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9011 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9012 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9015 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9016 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9017 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9019 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9020 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9021 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9022 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9024 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9025 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9027 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9028 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9029 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9030 default. For example, with this lookup:
9032 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9034 the file could contains lines like this:
9036 user1@domain1.example
9039 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9042 nimrod@jaeger.example
9046 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9047 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9049 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9051 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9052 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9054 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9055 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9056 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9060 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9061 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9066 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9067 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9068 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9069 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9070 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9071 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9072 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9073 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9074 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9076 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9077 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9078 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9079 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9080 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9083 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9085 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9087 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9089 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9091 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9092 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9093 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9094 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9095 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9096 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9098 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9101 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9104 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9105 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9106 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9107 might have entries like
9109 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9110 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9113 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9114 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9115 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9116 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9118 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9119 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9120 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9123 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9124 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9125 can only return a single list of local parts.
9128 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9129 in these two examples:
9132 senders = *@+my_list
9134 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9135 example it is a named domain list.
9140 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9141 .cindex "case of local parts"
9142 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9143 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9144 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9145 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9146 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9147 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9148 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9149 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9152 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9153 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9154 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9155 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9156 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9157 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9158 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9161 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9162 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9163 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9164 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9165 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9166 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9167 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9168 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9172 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9173 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9174 .cindex "local part" "list"
9175 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9176 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9177 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9178 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9179 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9180 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9181 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9182 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9184 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9185 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9186 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9187 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9188 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9189 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9190 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9192 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9197 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9198 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9200 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9201 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9202 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9203 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9205 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9206 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9207 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9208 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9209 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9210 escape character, as described in the following section.
9212 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9213 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9214 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9215 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9216 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9221 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9222 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9223 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9224 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9225 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9226 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9227 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9228 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9230 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9231 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9232 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9233 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9235 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9237 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9238 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9243 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9244 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9245 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9246 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9247 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9248 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9249 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9252 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9253 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9254 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9257 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9258 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9259 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9261 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9262 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9263 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9264 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9265 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9266 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9267 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9270 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9271 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9272 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9275 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9276 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9277 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9278 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9280 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9282 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9283 Exim message identifier. For example:
9285 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9287 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9288 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9291 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9292 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9293 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9294 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9295 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9296 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9297 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9298 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9299 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9300 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9301 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9302 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9308 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9309 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9310 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9311 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9312 white space is significant.
9315 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9316 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9317 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9322 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9323 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9324 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9325 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9326 given, the expansion fails.
9328 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9329 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9330 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9331 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9335 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9336 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9337 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9338 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9339 string easier to understand.
9341 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9342 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9343 expansion item below.
9346 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9347 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9348 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9349 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9350 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9351 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9352 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9353 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9354 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9355 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9356 the result of the expansion.
9357 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9358 the expansion result is an empty string.
9359 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9362 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9363 .cindex authentication "results header"
9364 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9365 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9366 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9367 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9369 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9370 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9371 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9380 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9382 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9384 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9387 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9388 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9389 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9390 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9391 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9392 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9393 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9394 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9398 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9399 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9404 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9408 If the field is found,
9409 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9410 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9411 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9412 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9414 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9415 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9418 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9420 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9421 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9423 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9424 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9425 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9426 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9427 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9428 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9429 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9430 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9432 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9433 take an optional modifier of "int"
9434 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9435 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9436 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9438 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9439 newline-separated by default,
9440 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9441 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9442 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9444 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9445 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9446 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9447 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9448 if so the element tags are omitted.
9450 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9452 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9453 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9455 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9456 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9460 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9461 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9462 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9464 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9465 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9466 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9467 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9468 must have the following type:
9470 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9472 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9473 function should return one of the following values:
9475 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9476 into the expanded string that is being built.
9478 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9479 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9481 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9482 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9484 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9486 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9487 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9488 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9491 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9492 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9493 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9494 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9496 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9497 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9498 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9500 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9501 appear, for example:
9503 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9505 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9506 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9508 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9510 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9513 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9514 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9517 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9518 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9519 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9520 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9521 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9522 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9523 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9524 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9526 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9529 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9530 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9531 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9532 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9533 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9534 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9535 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9536 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9537 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9539 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9540 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9541 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9544 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9545 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9547 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9548 appear, for example:
9550 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9552 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9553 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9555 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9556 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9557 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9558 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9559 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9560 .cindex JSON expansions
9561 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9562 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9563 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9564 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9566 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9569 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9570 the spaces are optional.
9571 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9572 For the &"json"& variant,
9573 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9576 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9577 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9579 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9581 The results of matching are handled as above.
9584 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9585 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9586 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9587 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9588 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9589 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9590 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9591 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9592 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9593 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9594 <&'string3'&> as before.
9596 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9597 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9598 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9599 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9600 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9601 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9602 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9603 provided. For example:
9605 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9609 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9611 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9612 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9615 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9616 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9617 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9618 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9619 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9620 .cindex JSON expansions
9621 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9622 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9624 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9625 there is no choice of field separator.
9626 For the &"json"& variant,
9627 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9630 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9631 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9635 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9636 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9637 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9639 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9640 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9642 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9643 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9644 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9645 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9646 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9648 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9650 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9651 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9654 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9655 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9656 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9657 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9658 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9659 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9661 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9662 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9663 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9664 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9666 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9668 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9669 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9670 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9671 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9672 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9674 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9676 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9677 letters appear. For example:
9679 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9680 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9681 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9684 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9685 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9686 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9687 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9688 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9689 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9690 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9691 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9692 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9693 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9694 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9695 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9696 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9697 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9698 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9699 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9700 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9704 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9705 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9706 lines) may be present.
9708 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9709 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9712 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9713 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9714 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9717 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9718 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9719 are multiple headers with a given name.
9720 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9721 list-processing facilities can be used.
9722 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9723 the content is &"raw"&.
9726 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9727 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9728 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9729 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9730 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9731 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9732 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9733 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9736 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9737 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9738 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9739 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9740 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9741 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9744 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9745 command of the following form:
9747 headers charset "UTF-8"
9749 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9750 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9751 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9752 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9753 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9756 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9757 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9758 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9759 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9761 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9762 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9763 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9764 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9765 router or transport are not accessible.
9767 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9768 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9769 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9770 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9771 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9772 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9773 point they are added.
9774 When any of the above ACLs ar
9775 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9777 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9778 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9779 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9780 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9781 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9782 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9783 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9786 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9787 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9788 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9789 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9790 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9791 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9792 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9793 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9796 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9797 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9799 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9800 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9801 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9802 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9803 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9804 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9805 present. For example:
9807 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9809 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9812 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9814 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9815 an Exim configuration:
9817 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9819 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9822 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9823 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9824 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9826 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9827 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9828 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9829 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9830 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9831 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9834 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9835 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9836 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9837 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9838 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9839 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9841 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9843 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9844 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9845 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9846 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9847 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9849 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9850 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9851 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9853 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9857 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9862 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9863 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9864 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9865 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9866 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9867 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9871 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9872 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9873 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9874 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9875 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9876 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9877 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9880 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9882 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9883 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9884 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9885 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9888 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9889 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9890 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9891 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9892 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9893 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9894 apart from an optional leading minus,
9895 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9897 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9898 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9900 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9901 If the number is negative, the fields are
9902 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9903 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9904 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9906 If the modulus of the
9907 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9908 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9912 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9916 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9918 yields &"result: 42"&.
9920 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9921 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9923 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9926 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9927 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9928 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9929 described in the next item.
9931 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9932 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9933 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9934 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9935 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9936 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9937 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9938 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9939 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9941 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9942 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9943 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9944 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9945 out by the system administrator.
9948 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9949 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9950 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9951 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9952 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9953 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9954 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9955 original lookup fails.
9957 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9958 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9959 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9960 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9961 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9962 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9963 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9964 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9966 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9967 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9968 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9969 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9971 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9972 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9973 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9974 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9976 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9978 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9980 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9981 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9983 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9988 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9989 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9991 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9992 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9994 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9995 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9996 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9997 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9999 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10001 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10002 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
10003 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
10005 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10006 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10007 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10008 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10009 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10010 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10011 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10013 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10015 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10016 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10017 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10018 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10021 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10023 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10027 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10028 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10029 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10030 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10031 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10032 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10033 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10034 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10036 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10037 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10038 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10039 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10040 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10043 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10044 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10045 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10047 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10048 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10051 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10052 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10053 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10054 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10055 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10056 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10057 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10058 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10060 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10061 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10062 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10063 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10064 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10065 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10066 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10067 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10068 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10069 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10071 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10072 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10073 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10074 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10076 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10077 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10078 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10079 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10080 is the expansion of the third argument.
10082 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10083 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10084 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10086 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10087 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10088 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10089 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10090 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10091 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10092 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10093 newlines are left in the string.
10094 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10095 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10096 the string expansion fails.
10098 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10099 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10103 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10104 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10105 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10106 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10107 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10108 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10109 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10112 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10113 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10115 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10116 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10117 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10118 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10119 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10122 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10124 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10125 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10126 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10127 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10128 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10129 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10130 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10132 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10135 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10136 and must be present if the argument is given.
10137 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10138 Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10139 The first defines whether (the default)
10140 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10141 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10143 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10145 The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10147 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10149 The default is to not use TLS.
10150 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10152 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10153 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10154 turns them into spaces:
10156 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10158 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10159 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10160 addition, the following errors can occur:
10163 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10165 Failure to connect the socket;
10167 Failure to write the request string;
10169 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10172 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10173 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10174 errors occurs. For example:
10176 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10179 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10180 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10181 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10182 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10183 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10185 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10186 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10189 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10190 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10191 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10192 .vindex "&$value$&"
10194 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10195 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10196 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10197 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10198 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10199 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10200 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10201 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10202 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
10203 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10205 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10207 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10210 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10212 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10213 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
10216 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10217 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10218 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10220 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10221 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10222 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10223 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10224 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10225 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10226 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10227 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10228 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10230 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10231 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10232 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10233 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10234 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10235 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10236 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10237 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10238 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10241 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10242 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10243 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10244 .vindex "&$value$&"
10245 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10246 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10247 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10248 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10249 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10252 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10253 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10254 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10255 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10257 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10258 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10259 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10262 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10263 log_message = Output of id: $value
10265 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10266 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10268 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10271 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10272 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10273 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10275 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10276 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10280 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10281 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10284 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10285 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10286 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10287 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10289 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10290 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10293 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10294 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10295 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10296 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10297 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10298 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10299 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10300 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10302 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10304 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10305 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10306 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10308 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10310 yields &"defabc"&, and
10312 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10314 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10315 the regular expression from string expansion.
10317 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10318 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10321 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10322 .cindex sorting "a list"
10323 .cindex list sorting
10324 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10325 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10326 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10327 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10328 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10329 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10330 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10331 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10332 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10333 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10334 to give values for comparison.
10336 The item result is a sorted list,
10337 with the original list separator,
10338 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10342 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10344 sorts a list of numbers, and
10346 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10348 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10351 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10352 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10353 .cindex "substring extraction"
10354 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10355 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10356 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10357 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10358 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10360 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10362 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10363 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10366 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10367 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10368 length required. For example
10370 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10372 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10373 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10374 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10375 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10377 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10378 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10379 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10381 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10383 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10384 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10385 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10387 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10389 yields an empty string, but
10391 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10395 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10396 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10397 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10398 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10401 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10403 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10405 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10409 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10410 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10411 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10412 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10413 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10414 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10415 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10416 replacement list. For example
10418 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10420 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10421 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10422 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10425 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10431 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10432 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10433 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10434 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10435 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10436 following operations can be performed:
10439 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10440 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10441 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10442 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10443 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10444 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10446 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10449 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10450 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10451 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10452 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10453 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10454 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10455 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10456 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10457 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10459 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10460 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10461 character. For example:
10463 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10465 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10466 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10467 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10468 separator explicitly:
10470 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10473 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10474 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10475 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10478 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10479 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10480 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10481 email address separator. For the example header line:
10483 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10485 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10486 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10487 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10488 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10489 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10490 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10491 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10493 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10494 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10496 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10497 Last:user@example.com
10498 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10500 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10504 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10505 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10506 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10507 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10508 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10509 Only lowercase letters are used.
10511 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10512 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10513 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10514 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10515 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10517 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10518 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10519 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10520 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10521 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10522 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10523 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10524 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10525 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10527 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10528 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10529 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10530 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10531 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10532 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10535 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10536 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10537 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10538 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10539 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10540 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10542 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10543 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10546 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10547 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10548 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10549 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10550 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10553 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10554 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10555 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10556 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10557 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10560 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10561 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10562 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10563 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10564 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10565 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10566 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10568 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10569 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10570 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10571 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10572 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10573 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10576 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10577 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10578 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10579 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10580 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10581 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10582 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10583 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10584 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10585 C programming language):
10587 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10588 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10589 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10590 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10591 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10593 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10595 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10596 space is permitted before or after operators.
10598 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10599 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10600 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10601 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10602 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10604 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10606 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10607 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10610 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10611 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10612 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10613 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10614 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10615 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10616 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10617 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10618 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10619 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10620 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10623 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10625 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10628 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10631 {$recipients_count} \
10632 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10636 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10637 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10640 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10641 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10642 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10645 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10647 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10648 and then re-expands what it has found.
10651 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10653 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10654 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10655 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10656 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10657 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10658 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10659 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10660 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10661 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10663 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10664 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10665 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10666 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10667 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10668 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10669 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10672 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10673 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10674 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10675 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10676 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10677 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10679 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10681 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10682 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10686 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10687 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10688 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10689 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10690 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10691 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10695 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10696 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10697 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10698 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10699 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10700 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10701 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10704 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10705 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10706 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10707 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10708 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10709 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10710 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10712 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10713 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10714 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10715 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10716 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10717 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10718 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10719 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10720 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10723 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10724 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10725 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10726 .cindex "lower casing"
10727 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10728 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10729 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10733 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10735 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10736 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10737 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10738 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10739 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10740 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10742 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10744 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10745 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10746 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10747 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10750 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10751 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10752 .cindex "list" "item count"
10753 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10754 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10755 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10758 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10759 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10760 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10761 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10762 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10763 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10764 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10765 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10766 matching list is returned.
10769 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10770 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10771 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10772 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10773 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10775 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10778 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10779 .cindex "masked IP address"
10780 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10781 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10782 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10783 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10784 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10785 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10786 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10787 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10788 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10790 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10792 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10793 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10794 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10795 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10797 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10801 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10803 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10806 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10808 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10809 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10810 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10811 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10812 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10814 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10815 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10818 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10819 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10820 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10821 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10822 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10823 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10825 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10827 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10830 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10831 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10832 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10833 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10834 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10835 is an empty string or
10836 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10837 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10838 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10839 respectively For example,
10847 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10848 variable or a message header.
10850 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10851 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10852 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10853 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10854 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10855 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10856 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10858 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10859 will likely use the quoting form.
10860 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10863 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10864 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10865 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10866 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10867 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10869 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10875 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10876 yields an unchanged string.
10879 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10880 .cindex "random number"
10881 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10882 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10883 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10884 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10885 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10886 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10887 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10888 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10892 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10893 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10894 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10895 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10896 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10897 for DNS. For example,
10899 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10900 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10905 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10909 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10910 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10911 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10912 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10913 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10914 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10915 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10916 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10917 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10920 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10922 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10923 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10927 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10928 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10929 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10930 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10931 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10932 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10933 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10934 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10936 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10937 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10938 to use this operator as well.
10942 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10943 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10944 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10945 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10946 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10947 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10948 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10951 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10952 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10953 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10954 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10955 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10956 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10957 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10959 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10960 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10963 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10964 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10965 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10966 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10967 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
10968 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10969 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10970 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10971 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10972 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10974 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10976 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10977 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10980 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
10981 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
10982 Finally, if an underbar
10983 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
10984 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
10985 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
10989 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10990 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10991 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10992 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10993 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10994 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10996 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10998 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10999 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11000 with 256 being the default.
11002 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11003 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11004 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11005 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11008 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11009 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11010 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11011 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11012 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11013 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11014 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11015 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11016 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11017 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11018 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11019 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11020 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11022 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11023 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11024 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11026 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11027 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11028 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11032 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11033 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11034 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11035 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11036 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11037 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11038 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11041 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11042 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11043 .cindex "substring extraction"
11044 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11045 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11046 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11047 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11049 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11051 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11052 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11053 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11055 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11056 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11057 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11058 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11061 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11062 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11063 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11064 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11065 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11066 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11069 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11070 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11071 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11072 .cindex "upper casing"
11073 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11074 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11075 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11076 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11078 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11079 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11080 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11081 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11082 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11083 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11084 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11085 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11086 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11087 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11088 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11089 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11090 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11091 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11093 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11095 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11096 literal question mark).
11098 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11099 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11100 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11101 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11102 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11103 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11105 .cindex internationalisation
11106 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11107 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11108 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11109 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11110 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11111 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11119 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11120 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11121 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11122 while expanding strings:
11125 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11126 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11127 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11128 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11131 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11132 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11133 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11134 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11140 &`>= `& greater or equal
11142 &`<= `& less or equal
11146 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11148 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11149 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11150 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11151 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11152 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11155 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11156 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11157 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11160 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11161 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11162 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11163 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11164 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11165 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11166 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11167 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11168 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11169 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11170 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11171 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11172 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11173 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11175 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11176 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11177 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11178 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11179 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11180 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11182 An empty string is treated as false.
11183 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11184 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11185 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11187 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11188 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11191 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11195 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11196 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11197 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11198 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11199 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11200 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11201 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11202 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11204 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11206 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11207 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11208 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11209 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11210 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11211 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11212 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11213 included in the binary.
11215 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11216 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11217 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11218 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11219 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11220 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11221 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11222 string in LDAP form is:
11224 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11226 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11227 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11229 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11231 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11236 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11237 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11238 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11239 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11240 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11241 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11245 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11246 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11247 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11248 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11249 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11250 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11253 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11254 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11255 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11256 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11257 whatever its length.
11260 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11261 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11262 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11263 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11265 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11266 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11267 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11268 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11269 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11270 support &[crypt16()]&.
11272 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11273 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11274 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11275 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11276 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11278 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11279 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11280 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11282 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11283 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11284 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11285 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11286 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11288 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11289 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11290 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11291 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11292 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11293 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11295 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11297 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11298 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11300 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11301 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11302 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11303 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11304 exists in the message. For example,
11306 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11308 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11309 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11311 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11312 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11313 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11314 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11315 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11316 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11317 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11318 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11319 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11320 case is defined per the system C locale.
11322 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11323 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11324 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11325 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11326 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11327 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11328 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11329 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11331 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11332 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11333 .cindex "first delivery"
11334 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11335 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11336 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11337 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11340 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11341 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11342 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11343 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11344 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11346 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11347 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11348 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11349 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11350 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11351 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11353 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11354 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11355 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11357 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11358 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11359 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11361 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11362 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11363 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11364 list separator is changed to a comma:
11366 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11368 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11369 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11371 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11374 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11375 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11376 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11377 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11378 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11379 .cindex JSON expansions
11380 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11381 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11382 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11383 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11384 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11386 The array separator is not changeable.
11387 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11388 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11393 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11394 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11395 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11396 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11397 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11398 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11399 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11400 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11401 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11403 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11405 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11406 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11407 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11408 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11409 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11410 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11411 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11412 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11413 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11415 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11417 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11418 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11419 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11420 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11421 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11422 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11424 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11426 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11427 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11429 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11430 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11431 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11432 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11435 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11436 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11437 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11438 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11439 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11440 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11441 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11442 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11443 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11444 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11445 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11447 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11448 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11449 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11450 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11451 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11453 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11454 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11456 This is no longer the case.
11458 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11459 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11461 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11463 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11465 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11466 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11467 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11468 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11469 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11470 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11471 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11472 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11473 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11474 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11475 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11476 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11477 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11481 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11482 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11483 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11484 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11485 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11486 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11487 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11488 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11489 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11491 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11493 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11494 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11495 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11496 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11497 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11498 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11499 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11500 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11501 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11503 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11506 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11507 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11508 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11509 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11510 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11511 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11512 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11513 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11514 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11515 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11516 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11519 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11521 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11522 backslashes is also required.
11524 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11525 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11526 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11527 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11528 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11529 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11530 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11531 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11533 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11534 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11535 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11536 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11537 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11538 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11539 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11540 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11542 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11543 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11544 See &*match_local_part*&.
11546 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11547 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11548 See &*match_local_part*&.
11550 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11551 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11552 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11553 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11554 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11555 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11557 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11559 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11562 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11564 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11566 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11567 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11568 in a single test such as
11569 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11570 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11571 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11572 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11574 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11576 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11578 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11580 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11581 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11582 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11583 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11584 masks. For example:
11586 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11588 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11589 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11590 address mask, for example:
11592 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11594 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11595 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11597 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11601 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11602 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11604 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11606 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11607 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11608 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11609 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11610 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11611 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11612 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11613 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11616 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11618 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11619 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11620 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11621 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11623 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11625 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11626 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11627 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11628 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11631 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11632 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11634 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11635 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11636 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11637 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11639 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11640 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11641 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11642 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11643 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11644 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11645 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11646 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11647 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11648 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11649 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11653 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11654 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11656 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11657 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11658 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11659 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11660 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11661 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11662 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11664 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11665 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11666 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11667 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11668 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11670 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11672 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11674 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11676 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11677 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11678 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11679 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11682 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11683 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11685 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11686 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11687 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11688 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11689 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11690 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11692 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11693 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11694 building Exim. For example:
11696 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11698 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11699 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11700 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11701 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11703 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11704 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11705 configuration, you might have this:
11707 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11709 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11711 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11713 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11714 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11715 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11716 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11717 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11718 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11721 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11723 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11724 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11725 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11726 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11727 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11730 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11731 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11732 this library, you need to set
11734 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11736 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11737 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11739 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11741 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11742 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11743 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11745 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11746 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11747 the authentication is successful. For example:
11749 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11753 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11754 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11755 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11757 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11758 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11759 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11760 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11761 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11762 by a process that is not running as root.
11764 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11765 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11766 building Exim. For example:
11768 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11770 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11771 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11772 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11774 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11775 two are mandatory. For example:
11777 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11779 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11780 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11781 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11786 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11787 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11788 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11789 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11790 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11791 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11792 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11796 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11797 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11798 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11799 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11800 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11803 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11805 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11806 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11807 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11809 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11810 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11811 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11812 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11813 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11814 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11815 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11816 parsed but not evaluated.
11818 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11823 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11824 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11825 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11826 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11827 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11830 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11831 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11832 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11833 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11834 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11835 In the expansion condition case
11836 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11837 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11838 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11839 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11840 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11841 matching condition.
11843 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11844 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11845 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11846 any unused variables being made empty.
11848 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11849 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11850 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11851 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11852 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11853 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11854 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11855 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11856 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11857 during subsequent delivery.
11859 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11860 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11861 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11862 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11863 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11864 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11865 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11866 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11869 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11870 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11871 this variable has the number of arguments.
11873 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11874 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11875 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11876 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11877 be preserved by coding like this:
11879 warn !verify = sender
11880 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11882 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11883 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11886 .vitem &$address_data$&
11887 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11888 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11889 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11890 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11891 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11892 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11895 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11896 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11897 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11898 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11899 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11900 from the child's routing.
11902 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11903 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11904 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11907 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11908 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11909 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11911 .vitem &$address_file$&
11912 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11913 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11914 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11915 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11916 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11918 /home/r2d2/savemail
11920 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11921 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11922 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11923 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11924 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11925 to the relevant file.
11927 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11928 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11929 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11930 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11932 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11933 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11934 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11935 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11937 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11938 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11939 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11940 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11941 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11942 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11943 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11944 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11945 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11947 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11948 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11949 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11950 command line option.
11951 This second case also sets up information used by the
11952 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11954 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11955 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11956 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11957 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11958 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11959 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11960 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11961 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11962 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11966 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11967 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11968 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11969 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11970 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11971 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11972 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11973 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11974 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11975 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11976 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11978 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11979 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11980 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11981 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11982 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11985 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11986 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11987 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11988 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11989 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11990 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11991 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11992 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11993 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11994 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11995 an undefined mechanism.
11997 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11998 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11999 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12000 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12001 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12002 the ACL malware condition.
12004 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12005 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12006 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12007 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12008 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12009 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12011 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12012 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12013 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12014 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12015 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12016 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12017 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12019 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12020 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12021 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12022 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12023 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12025 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12026 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12027 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12028 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12029 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12031 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12032 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12033 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12034 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12035 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12036 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12037 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12039 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12040 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12041 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12042 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12043 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12044 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12045 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12047 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12048 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12049 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12050 address that was connected to.
12052 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12053 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12054 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12055 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12056 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12058 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12059 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12060 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12061 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12062 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12063 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12065 .vitem &$config_file$&
12066 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12067 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12069 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12070 Results of DKIM verification.
12071 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12073 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12074 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12075 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12076 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12077 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12079 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12080 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12081 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12082 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12083 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12084 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12085 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12086 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12087 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12088 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12089 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12090 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12091 &$dkim_key_length$&
12092 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12093 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12095 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12096 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12097 When a message has been received this variable contains
12098 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12099 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12101 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12102 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12103 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12105 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12106 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12107 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12108 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12109 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12110 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12111 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12112 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12113 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12116 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12117 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12118 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12119 case for &$domain$&.
12121 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12122 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12123 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12124 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12126 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12127 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12128 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12129 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12130 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12131 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12133 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12134 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12135 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12137 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12140 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12141 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12142 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12143 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12144 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12145 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12146 the &(smtp)& transport.
12149 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12150 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12151 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12152 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12155 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12156 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12157 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12158 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12159 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12160 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12163 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12164 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12165 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12166 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12170 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12171 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12172 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12173 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12174 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12175 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12176 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12179 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12180 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12181 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12184 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12185 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12186 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12188 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12189 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12190 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12192 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12193 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12194 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12196 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12197 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12198 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12199 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12200 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12201 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12202 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12204 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12205 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12206 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12207 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12208 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12209 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12211 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12212 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12213 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12214 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12215 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12219 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12220 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12221 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12222 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12223 by a setting on the transport itself.
12225 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12226 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12227 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12231 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12232 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12233 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12234 to local and remote transports.
12236 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12237 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12238 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12239 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12240 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12241 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12242 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12245 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12246 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12247 client is connected.
12250 .vitem &$host_address$&
12251 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12252 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12253 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12254 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12256 .vitem &$host_data$&
12257 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12258 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12259 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12260 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12262 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12263 message = $host_data
12265 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12266 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12267 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12268 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12269 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12270 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12271 variables is set to &"1"&.
12274 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12275 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12278 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12279 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12280 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12283 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12284 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12285 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12286 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12287 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12288 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12289 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12290 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12291 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12292 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12294 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12295 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12296 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12299 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12300 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12301 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12303 .vitem &$host_port$&
12304 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12305 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12306 for an outbound connection.
12308 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12309 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12310 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12311 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12312 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12313 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12316 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12317 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12318 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12319 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12320 a unique name for the file.
12322 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12323 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12324 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12326 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12327 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12328 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12332 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12333 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12334 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12338 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12339 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12340 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12343 .vitem &$load_average$&
12344 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12345 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12346 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12347 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12349 .vitem &$local_part$&
12350 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12351 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12352 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12353 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12354 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12356 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12357 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12358 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12359 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12362 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12363 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12364 .cindex affix variables
12365 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12366 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12367 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12368 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12370 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12371 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12372 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12375 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12376 local part of the recipient address.
12378 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12379 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12380 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12382 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12385 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12386 abc\:xyz@test.example
12388 the value of &$local_part$& is
12392 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12393 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12396 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12398 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12399 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12400 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12402 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12403 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12404 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12405 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12406 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12407 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12408 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12410 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12411 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12412 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12413 variable expands to nothing.
12415 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12416 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12417 .cindex affix variables
12418 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12419 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12420 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12422 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12423 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12424 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12425 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12426 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12428 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12429 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12430 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12431 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12433 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12434 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12435 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12437 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12438 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12439 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12440 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12441 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12442 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12443 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12444 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12446 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12447 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12448 This contains the expanded value of the
12449 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12452 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12453 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12454 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12455 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12456 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12457 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12459 .vitem &$log_space$&
12460 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12461 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12462 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12463 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12464 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12465 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12468 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12469 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12470 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12471 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12472 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12473 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12474 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12475 and &"yes"& if it was.
12476 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12477 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12478 as authenticated data.
12480 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12481 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12482 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12483 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12484 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12485 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12486 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12489 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12490 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12491 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12492 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12493 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12495 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12496 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12497 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12498 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12499 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12500 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12502 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12504 .vitem &$message_age$&
12505 .cindex "message" "age of"
12506 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12507 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12508 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12511 .vitem &$message_body$&
12512 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12513 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12514 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12515 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12516 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12517 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12518 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12519 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12520 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12522 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12523 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12524 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12525 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12526 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12528 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12529 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12530 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12531 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12532 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12533 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12536 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12537 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12538 .cindex "message body" "size"
12539 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12540 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12541 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12542 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12543 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12545 If the spool file is wireformat
12546 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12547 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12549 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12550 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12551 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12552 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12553 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12554 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12555 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12556 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12558 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12559 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12560 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12561 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12562 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12563 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12565 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12566 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12567 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12568 contents of header lines is done.
12570 .vitem &$message_id$&
12571 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12573 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12574 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12575 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12576 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12577 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12578 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12579 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12580 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12581 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12582 from the body is not counted.
12584 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12585 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12586 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12587 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12588 header and the body).
12590 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12592 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12594 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12596 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12597 message has not yet been received.
12599 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12601 .vitem &$message_size$&
12602 .cindex "size" "of message"
12603 .cindex "message" "size"
12604 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12605 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12606 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12607 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12608 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12609 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12610 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12611 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12612 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12614 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12615 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12616 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12617 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12619 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12620 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12621 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12622 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12624 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12625 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12626 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12628 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12629 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12630 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12631 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12632 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12633 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12634 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12635 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12636 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12637 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12639 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12640 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12641 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12643 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12644 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12645 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12646 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12647 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12648 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12649 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12650 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12651 the original address.
12653 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12654 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12655 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12656 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12657 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12659 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12660 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12661 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12663 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12664 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12665 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12666 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12667 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12668 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12669 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12670 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12671 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12673 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12674 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12675 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12676 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12677 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12678 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12679 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12680 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12683 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12684 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12685 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12686 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12688 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12689 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12690 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12691 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12694 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12696 This variable contains the current process id.
12698 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12699 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12700 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12701 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12702 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12703 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12704 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12705 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12706 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12707 variable"& error if encountered.
12709 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12710 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12711 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12712 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12713 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12714 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12715 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12718 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12719 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12720 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12721 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12723 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12725 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12727 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12728 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12729 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12730 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12732 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12733 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12734 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12735 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12737 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12738 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12739 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12740 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12742 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12743 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12744 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12745 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12747 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12748 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12749 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12751 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12752 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12753 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12754 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12756 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12757 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12758 .cindex "named queues"
12759 .cindex queues named
12760 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12765 .cindex router variables
12766 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12767 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12768 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12769 and the eventual transport.
12772 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12773 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12774 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12775 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12776 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12778 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12779 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12780 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12781 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12782 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12783 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12785 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12786 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12787 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12788 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12789 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12791 .vitem &$received_count$&
12792 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12793 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12794 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12795 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12798 .vitem &$received_for$&
12799 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12800 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12801 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12802 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12803 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12805 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12806 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12807 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12808 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12809 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12810 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12811 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12814 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12815 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12816 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12817 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12818 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12820 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12822 .vitem &$received_port$&
12823 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12824 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12826 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12827 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12828 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12829 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12830 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12831 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12832 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12833 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12834 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12836 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12837 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12838 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12839 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12840 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12841 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12843 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12844 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12845 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12847 .vitem &$received_time$&
12848 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12849 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12850 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12852 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12853 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12854 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12855 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12856 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12858 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12859 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12861 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12862 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12863 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12864 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12866 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12867 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12868 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12869 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12872 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12873 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12876 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12879 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12880 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12884 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12887 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12890 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12891 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12893 .vitem &$recipients$&
12894 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12895 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12896 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12897 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12898 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12902 In a system filter file.
12904 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12905 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12906 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12907 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12909 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12913 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12914 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12915 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12916 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12917 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12918 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12921 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12922 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12923 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12924 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12926 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12927 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12928 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12929 these variables contain the
12930 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12933 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12934 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12935 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12936 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12937 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12938 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12939 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12941 .vitem &$return_path$&
12942 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12943 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12944 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12945 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12946 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12947 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12948 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12949 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12950 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12951 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12954 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12955 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12956 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12958 .vitem &$router_name$&
12959 .cindex "router" "name"
12960 .cindex "name" "of router"
12961 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12962 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12965 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12966 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12967 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12968 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12969 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12970 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12971 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12974 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12975 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12976 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12977 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12978 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12979 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12980 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12981 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12983 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12984 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12985 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12986 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12987 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12988 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12990 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12991 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12992 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12993 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12994 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12995 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12996 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12997 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12999 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13000 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13001 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13003 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13004 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13005 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13007 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13008 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13009 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13010 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13011 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13014 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13015 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13017 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13018 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13019 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13020 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13022 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13023 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13024 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13025 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13026 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13027 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13028 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13029 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13030 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13031 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13032 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13033 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13034 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13036 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13037 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13038 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13039 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13040 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13042 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13043 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13044 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13045 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13046 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13047 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13049 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13050 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13051 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13052 this variable contains that
13053 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13055 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13056 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13057 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13058 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13059 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13060 &$authenticated_id$&.
13062 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13063 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13064 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13065 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13066 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13067 resolver library states that both
13068 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13069 other times, this variable is false.
13071 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13072 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13073 library, by setting:
13078 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13079 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13081 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13082 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13084 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13085 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13086 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13087 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13090 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13091 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13092 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13093 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13094 other means, this variable is empty.
13096 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13097 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13098 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13099 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13100 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13101 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13102 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13104 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13105 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13106 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13107 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13109 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13110 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13111 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13114 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13115 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13116 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13117 following are true:
13120 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13122 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13123 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13124 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13126 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13127 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13128 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13130 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13131 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13132 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13134 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13135 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13136 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13137 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13139 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13141 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13142 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13146 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13147 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13148 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13149 number that was used on the remote host.
13151 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13152 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13153 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13154 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13155 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13158 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13159 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13160 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13161 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13163 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13164 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13165 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13166 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13167 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13168 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13169 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13170 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13171 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13172 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13173 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13176 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13177 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13178 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13179 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13180 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13182 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13183 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13184 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13185 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13186 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13188 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13189 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13190 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13191 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13192 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13193 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13194 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13196 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13197 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13198 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13199 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13200 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13202 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13203 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13204 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13205 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13206 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13207 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13209 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13210 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13211 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13212 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13213 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13218 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13219 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13220 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13221 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13223 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13224 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13225 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13226 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13227 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13228 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13229 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13231 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13232 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13233 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13234 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13235 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13238 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13239 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13240 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13241 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13242 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13243 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13244 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13245 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13246 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13247 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13248 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13250 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13251 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13252 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13253 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13254 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13255 message is junk mail.
13257 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13258 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13259 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13260 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13262 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13263 &$spf_received$& &&&
13265 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13266 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13267 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13268 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13270 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13271 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13272 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13274 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13275 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13276 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13277 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13278 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13279 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13281 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13282 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13283 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13284 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13285 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13286 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13287 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13288 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13290 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13292 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13295 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13296 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13297 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13298 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13299 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13300 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13302 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13303 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13304 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13305 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13306 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13307 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13308 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13309 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13311 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13312 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13315 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13316 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13317 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13318 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13319 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13320 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13322 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13323 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13324 .cindex certificate variables
13325 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13326 inbound connection when the message was received.
13327 It is only useful as the argument of a
13328 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13329 or a &%def%& condition.
13331 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13332 when a list of more than one
13333 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13335 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13336 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13337 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13338 inbound connection when the message was received.
13339 It is only useful as the argument of a
13340 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13341 or a &%def%& condition.
13342 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13343 which is not the leaf.
13345 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13346 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13347 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13348 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13349 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13350 or a &%def%& condition.
13352 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13353 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13354 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13355 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13356 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13357 or a &%def%& condition.
13358 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13359 which is not the leaf.
13361 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13362 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13363 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13364 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13366 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13367 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13370 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13371 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13372 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13373 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13374 and &"0"& otherwise.
13376 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13377 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13378 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13379 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13380 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13381 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13382 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13383 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13384 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13386 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13387 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13388 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13391 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13392 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13393 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13396 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13397 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13399 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13400 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13401 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13402 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13405 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13406 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13407 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13410 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13411 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13412 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13414 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13415 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13416 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13417 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13419 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13420 1 No response to request
13421 2 Response not verified
13422 3 Verification failed
13423 4 Verification succeeded
13426 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13427 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13428 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13429 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13430 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13432 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13433 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13434 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13435 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13436 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13437 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13438 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13439 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13440 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13441 which is not the leaf.
13443 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13444 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13447 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13448 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13449 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13450 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13451 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13452 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13453 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13454 which is not the leaf.
13456 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13457 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13458 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13459 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13460 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13461 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13462 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13463 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13464 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13465 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13466 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13468 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13469 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13472 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13473 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13474 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13476 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13479 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13480 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13481 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13483 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13484 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13485 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13486 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13488 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13489 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13490 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13492 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13493 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13494 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13496 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13497 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13498 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13499 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13500 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13501 values for those that are behind (west).
13504 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13505 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13506 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13508 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13509 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13510 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13511 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13514 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13515 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13516 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13519 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13520 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13521 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13522 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13524 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13525 .cindex "transport" "name"
13526 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13527 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13528 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13531 .vindex "&$value$&"
13532 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13533 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13534 &*reduce*& expansion.
13536 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13537 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13538 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13539 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13542 .vitem &$version_number$&
13543 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13544 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13545 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13547 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13548 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13549 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13550 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13552 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13553 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13554 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13555 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13561 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13564 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13565 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13566 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13567 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13568 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13569 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13574 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13577 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13578 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13579 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13580 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13581 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13582 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13583 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13584 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13585 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13587 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13588 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13589 should usually be something like
13591 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13593 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13594 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13595 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13596 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13597 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13598 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13599 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13600 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13604 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13605 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13606 a startup when Exim is entered.
13608 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13609 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13612 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13613 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13616 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13617 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13618 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13619 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13620 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13621 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13625 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13626 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13627 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13628 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13632 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13633 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13635 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13636 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13637 with an error message of the form
13639 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13641 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13642 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13643 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13644 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13645 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13646 that was passed to &%die%&.
13649 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13650 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13651 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13654 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13656 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13657 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13658 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13660 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13661 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13662 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13663 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13665 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13666 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13667 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13668 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13669 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13670 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13671 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13674 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13675 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13676 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13677 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13678 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13679 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13680 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13681 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13682 avoided, but the output is lost.
13684 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13685 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13686 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13687 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13688 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13689 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13690 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13692 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13694 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13695 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13696 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13697 as the first subroutine argument.
13701 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13702 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13704 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13705 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13706 "Starting the daemon"
13707 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13708 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13709 .cindex "network interface"
13710 .cindex "interface" "network"
13711 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13712 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13713 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13714 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13715 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13716 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13717 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13718 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13719 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13720 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13721 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13724 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13725 and ports to listen on.
13727 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13728 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13729 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13730 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13731 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13732 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13733 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13734 as an error situation.
13736 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13737 for the outgoing connection.
13741 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13742 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13743 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13744 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13745 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13747 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13748 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13749 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13750 chapter describes how they operate.
13752 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13753 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13757 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13758 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13759 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13763 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13765 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13767 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13768 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13771 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13772 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13773 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13774 colons. For example:
13776 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13779 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13781 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13782 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13785 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13786 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13788 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13789 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13792 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13793 with a colon separator, for example:
13795 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13796 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13800 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13801 default setting contains just one port:
13803 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13805 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13806 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13807 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13808 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13809 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13813 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13814 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13815 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13816 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13817 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13818 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13820 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13822 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13824 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13826 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13830 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13831 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13832 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13833 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13834 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13835 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13838 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13839 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13840 If there are any items that do not
13841 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13842 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13843 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13844 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13848 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13851 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13853 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13854 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13855 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13859 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13860 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13861 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13862 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13863 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13864 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13865 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13866 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13867 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13868 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13869 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13870 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13871 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13874 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13875 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13876 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13878 The common use of this option is expected to be
13880 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13883 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13884 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13886 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13887 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13888 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13889 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13890 connections via the daemon.)
13895 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13896 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13897 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13898 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13899 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13900 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13901 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13902 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13904 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13906 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13907 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13908 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13909 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13910 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13911 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13913 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13915 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13916 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13917 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13918 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13919 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13921 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13922 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13923 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13924 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13925 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13926 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13927 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13928 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13929 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13930 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13931 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13932 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13934 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13935 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13936 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13937 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13938 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13942 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13943 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13945 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13946 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13948 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13949 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13950 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13951 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13953 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13955 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13957 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13959 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13960 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13962 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13963 IPv4 loopback address only:
13965 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13967 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13969 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13971 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13975 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13976 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13977 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13978 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13981 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13982 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13983 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13984 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13986 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13987 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13988 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13989 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13990 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13991 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13992 used for listening. Consider this example:
13994 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13996 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13998 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14000 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14001 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14004 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14005 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14006 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14007 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14008 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14009 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14010 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14011 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14015 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14016 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14017 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14018 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14019 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14020 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14026 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14027 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14029 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14030 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14031 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14032 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14035 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14036 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14038 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14039 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14040 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14042 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14043 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14044 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14045 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14049 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14050 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14051 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14052 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14053 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14054 listed in more than one group.
14056 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14058 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14059 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14060 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14061 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14062 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14063 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14064 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14065 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14066 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14067 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14068 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14072 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14074 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14075 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14076 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14077 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14078 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14079 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14084 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14086 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14087 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14088 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14089 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14090 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14091 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14092 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14093 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14094 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14095 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14096 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14097 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14102 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14104 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14105 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14106 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14107 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14108 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14109 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14110 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14111 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14112 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14113 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14114 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14115 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14116 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14117 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14118 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14123 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14125 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14126 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14127 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14128 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14133 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14135 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14136 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14137 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14138 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14139 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14140 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14141 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14142 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14143 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14144 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14145 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14146 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14147 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14148 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14149 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14154 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14156 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14157 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14162 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14164 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14165 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14166 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14171 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14173 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14174 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14175 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14176 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14177 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14178 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14179 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14184 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14186 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14187 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14188 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14189 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14190 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14191 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14192 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14193 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14194 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14195 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14196 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14197 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14198 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14199 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14200 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14201 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14203 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14204 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14205 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14206 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14207 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14212 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14214 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14215 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14216 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14217 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14218 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14219 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14220 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14221 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14222 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14223 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14224 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14225 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14226 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14227 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14228 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14229 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14230 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14231 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14232 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14233 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14234 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14235 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14237 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14238 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14239 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14240 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14241 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14242 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14243 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14244 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14245 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14246 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14247 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14248 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14249 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14250 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14251 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14252 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14253 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14254 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14255 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14256 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14261 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14263 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14265 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14267 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14268 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14269 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14274 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14276 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14277 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14278 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14279 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14280 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14281 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14282 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14283 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14284 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14285 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14286 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14287 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14288 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14289 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14290 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14291 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14292 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14297 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14299 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14300 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14301 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14302 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14303 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14304 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14305 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14306 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14311 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14313 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14314 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14315 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14316 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14317 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14318 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14319 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14320 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14326 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14328 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14335 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14336 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14339 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
14340 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14341 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14342 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14343 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14344 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14345 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14346 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14347 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14348 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14349 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14350 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14351 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14352 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14353 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14355 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14356 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14357 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14358 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14359 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14360 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14361 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14362 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14363 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14364 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14365 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14366 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14367 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14368 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14369 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14370 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14375 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14377 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14378 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14379 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14380 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14381 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14382 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14383 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14384 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14385 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14386 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14387 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14392 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14394 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14395 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14396 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14397 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14399 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14400 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14401 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14402 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14403 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14404 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14405 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14406 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14407 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14408 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14413 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14415 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14416 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14418 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14419 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14420 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14421 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14422 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14427 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14429 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14430 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14431 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14432 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14433 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14434 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14435 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14436 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14437 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14438 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14439 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14440 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14441 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14442 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14443 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14444 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14445 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14446 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14447 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14448 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14449 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14450 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14451 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14452 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14457 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14459 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14460 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14461 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14462 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14463 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14464 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14465 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14466 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14467 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14468 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14469 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14470 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14471 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14472 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14473 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14478 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14479 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14482 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14484 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14485 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14486 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14487 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14488 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14489 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14490 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14492 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14493 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14494 It now defaults to true.
14495 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14497 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14500 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14502 log_selector = +8bitmime
14505 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14506 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14507 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14508 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14509 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14512 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14513 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14514 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14517 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14518 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14519 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14520 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14521 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14523 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14524 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14525 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14526 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14527 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14529 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14530 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14531 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14532 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14534 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14535 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14536 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14537 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14538 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14540 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14541 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14542 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14543 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14544 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14545 This option defines the ACL that,
14546 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14547 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14548 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14549 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14551 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14552 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14553 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14554 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14555 of a received message.
14556 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14558 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14559 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14560 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14561 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14563 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14564 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14565 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14566 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14568 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14569 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14570 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14571 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14572 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14575 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14576 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14577 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14578 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14580 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14581 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14582 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14583 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14584 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14586 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14587 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14588 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14589 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14590 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14592 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14593 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14594 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14595 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14596 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14598 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14599 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14600 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14603 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14604 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14605 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14606 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14608 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14609 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14610 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14611 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14613 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14614 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14615 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14616 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14618 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14619 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14620 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14621 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14623 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14624 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14625 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14626 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14627 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14629 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14630 .cindex "admin user"
14631 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14632 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14633 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14634 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14635 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14636 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14637 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14639 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14640 .cindex "domain literal"
14641 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14642 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14643 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14644 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14646 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14647 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14648 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14649 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14650 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14651 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14652 the local host's IP addresses.
14655 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14656 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14657 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14658 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14659 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14660 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14661 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14662 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14663 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14665 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14666 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14667 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14668 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14669 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14670 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14671 experiment if they wish.
14673 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14674 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14675 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14676 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14677 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14678 suitable setting is:
14680 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14681 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14683 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14685 dns_check_names_pattern =
14687 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14690 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14691 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14692 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14693 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14694 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14695 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14696 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14697 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14698 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14699 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14700 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14702 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14703 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14704 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14705 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14706 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14707 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14709 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14710 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14711 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14712 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14714 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14716 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14717 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14718 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14719 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14722 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14723 .cindex "thawing messages"
14724 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14725 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14726 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14727 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14728 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14729 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14731 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14732 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14733 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14736 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14737 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14738 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14740 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14742 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14743 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14746 .option bi_command main string unset
14748 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14749 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14750 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14751 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14754 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14755 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14756 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14757 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14758 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14759 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14762 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14763 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14764 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14765 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14767 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14768 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14769 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14770 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14771 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14772 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14773 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14774 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14775 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14776 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14778 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14779 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14780 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14781 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14782 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14783 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14784 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14785 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14786 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14787 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14789 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14790 during reception of a message.
14791 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14793 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14796 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14797 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14798 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14799 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14802 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14803 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14804 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14805 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14806 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14807 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14808 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14809 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14810 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14812 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14813 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14814 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14815 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14816 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14819 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14820 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14821 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14822 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14823 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14824 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14825 connection. A typical setting might be:
14827 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14829 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14831 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14833 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14836 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14837 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14838 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14839 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14840 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14841 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14844 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14845 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14846 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14847 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14850 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14851 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14852 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14853 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14856 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14857 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14858 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14859 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14862 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14863 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14864 callout verification. The default value is
14866 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14868 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14871 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14872 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14875 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14876 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14878 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14879 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14880 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14881 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14882 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14883 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14884 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14885 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14886 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14887 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14890 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14891 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14894 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14895 .cindex "checking disk space"
14896 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14897 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14898 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14899 message is accepted.
14901 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14902 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14903 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14904 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14905 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14906 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14907 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14908 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14911 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14912 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14914 check_spool_space = 100M
14915 check_spool_inodes = 100
14917 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14918 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14921 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14922 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14923 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14925 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14926 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14927 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14928 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14929 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14930 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14932 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14933 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14934 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14936 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14937 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14938 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14940 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14941 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14942 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14943 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14945 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14946 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14947 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14948 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14950 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14952 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14953 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14954 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14955 administrative user.
14956 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14958 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14959 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14960 .cindex memory debugging
14961 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14962 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14963 it should normally be left as default.
14965 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14966 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14967 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14968 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14969 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14970 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14972 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14973 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14974 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14975 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14976 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14977 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14978 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14980 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14981 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14983 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14984 .cindex "warning of delay"
14985 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14986 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14987 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14988 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14989 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14990 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14991 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14992 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14995 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14997 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14998 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14999 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15000 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15004 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15005 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15007 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15009 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15010 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15011 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15013 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15014 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15015 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15016 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15017 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15018 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15019 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15020 not sent. The default is:
15022 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15023 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15024 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15025 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15028 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15029 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15030 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15031 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15033 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15034 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15035 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15036 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15037 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15038 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15039 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15040 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15042 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15043 .cindex "load average"
15044 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15045 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15046 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15047 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15048 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15051 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15052 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15053 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15054 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15055 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15056 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15057 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15058 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15060 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15061 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15062 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15063 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15064 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15065 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15066 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15067 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15069 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15070 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15071 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15072 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15075 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15076 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15077 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15078 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15079 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15080 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15081 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15084 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15085 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15086 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15087 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15088 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15089 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15092 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15093 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15094 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15095 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15096 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15097 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15098 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15099 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15100 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15101 by a setting such as this:
15103 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15105 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15106 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15107 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15108 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15109 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15110 options are applied after this global option.
15112 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15113 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15114 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15115 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15116 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15117 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15118 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15119 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15120 value of this option. The default pattern is
15122 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15123 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15125 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15126 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15127 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15128 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15129 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15132 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15133 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15134 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15136 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15137 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15138 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15139 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15141 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15142 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15143 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15144 not do it internally.
15145 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15146 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15148 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15149 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15150 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15153 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15154 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15155 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15156 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15157 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15158 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15160 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15163 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15164 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15165 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15166 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15167 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15168 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15169 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15170 domain matches this list.
15172 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15173 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15174 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15176 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15177 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15178 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15182 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15183 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15184 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15185 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15186 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15187 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15188 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15189 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15190 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15191 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15192 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15193 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15195 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15198 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15199 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15202 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15203 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15204 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15205 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15206 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15207 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15208 match with this expanded domain list.
15210 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15211 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15212 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15213 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15214 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15215 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15217 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15218 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15219 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15221 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15222 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15223 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15224 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15225 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15227 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15228 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15229 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15230 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15231 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15232 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15233 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15234 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15237 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15239 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15240 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15241 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15244 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15245 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15246 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15247 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15249 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15250 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15251 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15252 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15253 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15254 and accepted from, these hosts.
15255 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15256 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15257 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15258 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15261 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15262 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15263 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15264 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15265 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15266 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15268 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15270 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15271 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15273 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15274 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15275 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15276 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15277 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15278 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15279 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15280 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15281 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15284 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15285 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15286 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15287 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15288 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15289 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15290 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15291 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15292 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15294 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15295 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15296 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15297 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15298 are examined. For example:
15300 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15301 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15302 postmaster@mydomain.example
15304 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15305 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15306 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15307 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15308 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15309 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15310 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15313 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15314 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15315 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15317 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15319 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15320 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15321 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15322 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15323 overrides the default.
15325 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15326 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15327 and warning messages. For example:
15329 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15331 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15332 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15333 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15334 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15338 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15340 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15341 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15344 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15345 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15346 .cindex "Exim group"
15347 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15348 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15349 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15350 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15351 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15355 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15356 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15357 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15358 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15359 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15360 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15362 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15363 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15364 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15365 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15368 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15369 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15370 .cindex "Exim user"
15371 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15372 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15373 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15374 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15376 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15377 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15378 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15379 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15382 .option exim_version main string "current version"
15383 .cindex "Exim version"
15384 .cindex customizing "version number"
15385 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
15386 This option allows to override the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& Exim reports in
15387 various places. Use with care, this may fool stupid security scanners.
15390 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15391 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15392 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15393 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15396 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15397 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15399 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15400 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15402 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15403 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15404 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15405 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15406 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15407 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15408 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15409 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15410 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15411 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15415 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15416 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15417 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15418 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15419 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15420 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15421 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15422 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15425 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15426 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15427 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15428 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15432 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15433 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15434 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15435 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15436 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15437 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15438 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15439 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15440 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15441 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15442 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15443 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15444 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15445 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15446 logging that you require.
15449 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15451 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15452 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15453 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15454 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15455 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15456 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15457 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15458 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15460 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15461 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15462 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15465 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15466 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15467 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15468 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15470 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15474 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15475 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15478 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15479 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15480 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15481 implementations of TLS.
15484 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15485 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15486 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15489 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15494 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15495 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15496 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15497 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15498 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15499 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15503 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15504 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15505 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15506 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15507 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15508 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15509 sections are rejected.
15512 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15513 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15514 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15515 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15516 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15517 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15518 zero means &"no limit"&.
15523 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15524 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15525 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15526 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15527 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15528 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15529 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15530 if you want to do semantic checking.
15531 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15535 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15536 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15537 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15538 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15539 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15540 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15541 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15543 helo_allow_chars = _
15545 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15548 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15549 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15550 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15551 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15552 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15553 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15554 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15558 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15559 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15560 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15561 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15562 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15563 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15564 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15565 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15566 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15567 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15568 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15569 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15571 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15572 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15573 EHLO command either:
15576 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15578 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15579 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15580 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15581 calling host address, or
15583 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15586 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15587 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15588 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15590 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15591 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15592 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15594 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15595 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15596 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15597 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15598 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15599 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15600 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15601 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15602 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15605 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15606 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15607 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15608 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15609 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15610 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15611 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15612 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15613 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15615 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15616 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15617 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15618 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15619 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15621 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15622 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15623 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15624 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15627 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15628 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15629 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15630 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15631 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15632 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15633 default configuration file contains
15637 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15638 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15640 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15641 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15642 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15644 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15645 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15646 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15647 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15648 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15649 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15652 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15653 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15654 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15655 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15656 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15659 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15660 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15661 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15662 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15666 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15667 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15668 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15669 as soon as the connection is made.
15670 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15671 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15672 connections immediately.
15674 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15675 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15676 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15677 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15678 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15681 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15682 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15683 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15684 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15685 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15686 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15687 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15688 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15689 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15691 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15693 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15697 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15698 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15699 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15700 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15703 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15704 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15705 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15706 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15707 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15709 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15710 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15712 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15713 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15714 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15715 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15716 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15717 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15718 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15721 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15722 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15723 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15724 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15725 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15729 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15730 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15731 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15732 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15733 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15734 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15736 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15737 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15738 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15739 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15740 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15741 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15742 for frozen messages. For example,
15744 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15746 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15747 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15748 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15749 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15750 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15751 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15754 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15755 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15756 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15757 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15758 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15759 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15760 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15761 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15762 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15763 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15766 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15767 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15769 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15770 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15771 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15772 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15773 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15774 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15775 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15776 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15777 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15779 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15780 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15782 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15783 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15784 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15785 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15787 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15788 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15789 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15792 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15793 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15794 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15798 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15799 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15800 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15801 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15805 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15806 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15807 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15808 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15809 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15810 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15811 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15812 and constrained to be a directory.
15815 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15816 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15817 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15818 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15819 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15820 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15821 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15822 and constrained to be a file.
15825 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15826 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15827 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15828 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15829 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15830 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15833 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15834 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15835 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15836 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15837 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15838 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15839 identity to be proven.
15842 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15843 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15844 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15845 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15846 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15849 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15850 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15851 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15852 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15853 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15857 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15858 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15859 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15860 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15861 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15862 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15866 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15867 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15868 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15869 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15870 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15872 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15873 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15874 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15877 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15878 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15879 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15880 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15881 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15882 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15883 has been built with LDAP support.
15887 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15888 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15889 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15890 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15891 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15892 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15893 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15895 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15896 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15897 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15899 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15900 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15901 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15902 and the default qualify domain.
15904 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15905 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15906 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15907 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15909 .cindex "envelope from"
15910 .cindex "envelope sender"
15911 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15912 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15913 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15915 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15916 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15917 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15922 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15923 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15924 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15925 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15926 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15927 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15928 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15931 local_from_prefix = *-
15933 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15935 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15937 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15938 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15942 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15943 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15946 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15947 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15948 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15949 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15950 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15951 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15952 &%local_interfaces%& is
15954 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15956 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15958 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15961 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15962 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15963 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15964 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15965 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15966 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15967 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15968 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15972 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15973 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15974 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15975 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15976 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15977 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15978 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15979 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15984 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15985 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15986 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15987 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15988 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15989 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15990 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15991 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15992 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15993 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15994 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15995 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15996 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15997 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15998 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16002 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16003 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16004 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16005 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16006 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16007 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16008 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16009 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16010 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16011 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16012 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16013 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16014 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16015 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16016 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16019 .option log_selector main string unset
16020 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16021 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16022 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16023 minus characters. For example:
16025 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16027 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16028 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16031 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16032 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16033 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16034 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16035 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16036 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16037 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16038 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16039 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16040 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16041 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16042 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16043 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16046 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16047 .cindex "too many open files"
16048 .cindex "open files, too many"
16049 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16050 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16051 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16052 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16053 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16054 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16055 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16056 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16057 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16058 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16059 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16060 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16063 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16064 .cindex "length of login name"
16065 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16066 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16067 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16068 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16069 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16070 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16073 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16074 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16075 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16076 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16077 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16078 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16079 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16080 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16083 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16084 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16085 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16086 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16087 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16088 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16089 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16092 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16093 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16094 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16095 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16096 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16097 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16098 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16099 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16100 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16101 empty string, the option is ignored.
16104 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16105 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16106 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16107 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16108 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16109 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16110 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16111 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16112 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16113 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16114 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16115 colons will become hyphens.
16118 .option message_logs main boolean true
16119 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16120 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16121 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16122 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16123 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16124 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16125 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16126 which is not affected by this option.
16129 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16130 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16131 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16132 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16133 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16134 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16135 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16136 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16137 optionally followed by K or M.
16139 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16140 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16141 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16142 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16143 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16145 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16146 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16147 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16148 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16149 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16150 message that an individual transport can process.
16152 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16153 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16154 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16155 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16156 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16157 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16158 some problems may result.
16160 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16161 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16162 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16165 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16166 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16167 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16169 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16171 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16172 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16173 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16174 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16175 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16178 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16179 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16180 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16181 contains a full description of this facility.
16185 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16186 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16187 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16188 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16189 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16192 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16193 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16194 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16195 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16196 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16199 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16200 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16201 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16202 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16203 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16205 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16206 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16209 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16211 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16212 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16216 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
16217 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16218 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16219 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16220 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16222 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16223 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16224 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16225 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16226 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16227 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16228 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16230 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16231 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16232 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16233 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16234 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16236 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16238 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16239 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16240 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16241 some now infamous attacks.
16245 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16246 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16247 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16249 # Disable older protocol versions:
16250 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16253 Possible options may include:
16257 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16259 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16261 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16265 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16267 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16269 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16271 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16273 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16275 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16279 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16293 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16297 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16299 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16301 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16303 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16307 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16310 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16311 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16312 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16313 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16314 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16315 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16318 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16319 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16320 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16321 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16322 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16325 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16326 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16327 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16328 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16329 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16330 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16331 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16332 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16333 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16334 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16337 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16338 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16339 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16340 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16341 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16342 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16343 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16346 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16348 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16349 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16352 .option perl_startup main string unset
16354 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16355 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16357 .option perl_startup main boolean false
16359 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16362 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16363 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16364 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16365 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16366 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16367 PostgreSQL support.
16370 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16371 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16372 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16373 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16374 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16377 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16379 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16381 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16382 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16383 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16386 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16387 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16388 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16389 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16390 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16391 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16392 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16393 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16394 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16397 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16398 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16399 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16400 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16401 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16402 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16403 commands are acceptable.
16404 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16406 Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16410 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16411 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16412 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16413 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16414 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16415 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16416 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16417 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16419 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16420 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16421 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16422 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16423 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16424 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16425 volume of mail. Use with care!
16428 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16429 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16430 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16431 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16432 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16433 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16434 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16435 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16436 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16437 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16439 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16440 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16441 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16442 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16443 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16444 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16447 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16448 .cindex "printing characters"
16449 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16450 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16451 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16452 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16453 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16454 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16457 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16458 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16459 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16460 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16461 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16465 .option process_log_path main string unset
16466 .cindex "process log path"
16467 .cindex "log" "process log"
16468 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16469 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16470 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16471 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16472 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16473 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16474 different spool directories.
16477 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16478 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16482 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16483 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16484 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16487 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16488 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16489 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16490 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16491 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16492 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16493 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16494 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16495 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16497 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16498 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16499 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16500 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16501 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16502 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16503 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16506 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16507 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16508 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16512 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16513 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16514 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16515 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16516 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16517 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16518 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16519 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16522 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16523 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16525 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16526 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16527 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16528 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16531 .option queue_only main boolean false
16532 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16533 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16534 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16535 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16536 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16537 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16539 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16540 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16541 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16542 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16545 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16546 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16547 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16548 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16549 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16550 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16551 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16552 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16553 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16555 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16557 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16558 &_/some/file_& exists.
16561 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16562 .cindex "load average"
16563 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16564 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16565 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16566 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16567 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16568 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16569 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16572 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16573 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16574 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16575 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16578 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16579 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16580 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16581 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16582 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16583 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16584 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16585 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16586 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16587 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16588 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16589 re-evaluated for each message.
16592 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16593 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16594 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16595 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16596 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16597 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16600 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16601 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16602 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16603 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16604 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16605 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16606 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16607 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16608 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16609 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16610 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16611 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16612 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16616 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16617 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16618 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16619 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16620 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16621 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16622 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16623 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16624 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16626 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16627 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16628 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16629 the daemon's command line.
16631 .cindex queues named
16632 .cindex "named queues"
16633 To set limits for different named queues use
16634 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16636 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16637 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16638 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16639 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16640 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16641 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16642 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16643 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16644 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16645 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16646 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16647 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16648 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16652 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16653 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16654 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16655 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16656 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16657 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16658 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16660 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16661 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16662 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16663 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16664 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16665 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16666 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16667 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16668 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16671 The default setting is:
16674 received_header_text = Received: \
16675 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16676 {${if def:sender_ident \
16677 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16678 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16679 by $primary_hostname \
16680 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16681 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16682 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16683 ${if def:sender_address \
16684 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16685 id $message_exim_id\
16686 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16690 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16691 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16692 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16693 header lines such as the following:
16695 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16696 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16697 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16698 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16699 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16700 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16701 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16703 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16704 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16705 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16706 message was accepted.
16709 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16710 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16711 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16712 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16713 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16714 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16715 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16716 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16719 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16720 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16721 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16722 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16723 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16724 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16725 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16726 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16727 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16728 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16729 option was not set.
16732 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16733 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16734 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16735 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16736 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16737 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16738 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16739 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16742 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16743 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16744 RCPT commands in a single message.
16747 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16748 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16749 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16750 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16751 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16752 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16753 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16756 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16757 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16758 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16759 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16760 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16761 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16762 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16763 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16764 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16765 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16766 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16767 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16768 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16769 tagged with its process id.
16771 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16772 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16773 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16774 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16777 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16778 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16779 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16780 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16781 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16782 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16783 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16784 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16785 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16786 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16787 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16789 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16790 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16791 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16792 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16795 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16796 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16797 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16798 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16799 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16801 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16803 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16804 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16807 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16808 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16809 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16810 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16811 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16815 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16816 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16817 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16818 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16819 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16820 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16821 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16825 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16826 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16827 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16828 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16829 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16830 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16831 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16832 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16833 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16834 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16837 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16838 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16841 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16843 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16844 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16845 an item in the list.
16846 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16849 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16850 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16851 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16852 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16853 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16856 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16857 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16858 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16859 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16860 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16861 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16862 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16863 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16864 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16865 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16867 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16868 .cindex "environment"
16869 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16870 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16871 default list is empty,
16874 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16875 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16876 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16877 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16878 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16879 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16880 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16884 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16885 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16886 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16887 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16888 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16889 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16890 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16891 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16892 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16893 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16894 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16898 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16899 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16900 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16902 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16903 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16904 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16905 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16906 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16907 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16909 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16910 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16911 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16912 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16915 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16916 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16917 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16918 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16919 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16920 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16921 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16922 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16924 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16925 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16926 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16927 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16928 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16929 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16930 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16931 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16934 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16935 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16936 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16937 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16941 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16942 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16943 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16944 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16945 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16946 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16947 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16948 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16949 . the option name to split.
16951 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16952 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16953 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16954 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16955 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16956 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16957 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16958 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16959 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16963 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16964 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16965 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16966 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16967 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16968 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16969 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16970 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16971 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16972 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16973 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16975 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16976 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16977 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16978 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16979 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16980 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16984 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16985 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16986 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16987 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16988 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16989 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16990 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16991 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16992 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16993 to all messages received in the same connection.
16995 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16996 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16997 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16998 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17001 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17003 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17004 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17005 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17006 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17007 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17008 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17009 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17010 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17011 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17012 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17013 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17014 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17015 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17018 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17019 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17020 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17021 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17022 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17023 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17024 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17025 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17026 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17027 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17028 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17031 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17032 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17033 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17034 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17037 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17038 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17039 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17040 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17041 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17042 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17043 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17044 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17045 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17047 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17048 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17049 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17050 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17052 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17053 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17054 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17055 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17056 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17059 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17060 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17063 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17064 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17065 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17066 &%helo_data%& value.
17068 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17069 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17070 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17071 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17072 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17073 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17074 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17076 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17077 $version_number $tod_full
17079 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17080 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17081 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17082 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17083 multiline response).
17086 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17087 .cindex "checking disk space"
17088 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17089 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17090 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17091 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17092 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17093 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17094 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17097 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17098 .cindex "connection backlog"
17099 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17100 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17101 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17102 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17103 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17104 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17105 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17106 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17107 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17108 attacks by SYN flooding.
17111 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17112 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17113 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17114 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17115 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17116 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17117 fewer, but they still exist.
17119 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17120 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17121 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17122 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17123 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17124 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17125 does detect many instances.
17127 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17128 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17129 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17130 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17134 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17135 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17136 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17137 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17138 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17139 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17140 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17141 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17144 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17145 $sender_host_address
17147 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17148 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17149 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17150 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17151 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17155 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17156 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17157 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17158 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17159 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17162 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17163 .cindex "load average"
17164 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17165 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17166 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17167 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17168 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17169 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17173 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17174 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17175 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17176 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17177 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17179 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17181 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17182 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17183 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17184 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17185 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17187 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17188 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17189 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17190 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17191 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17192 not count towards the limit.
17196 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17197 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17198 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17199 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17200 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17203 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17204 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17208 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17209 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17210 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17211 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17212 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17213 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17216 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17217 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17218 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17219 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17221 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17222 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17223 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17224 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17228 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17230 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17231 fractional parts are allowed here.
17233 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17235 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17236 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17239 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17240 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17242 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17243 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17245 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17246 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17247 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17248 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17251 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17252 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17255 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17256 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17259 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17260 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17261 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17262 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17263 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17264 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17265 the message is abandoned.
17266 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17268 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17269 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17271 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17272 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17274 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17275 expanded before use and may depend on
17276 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17280 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17281 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17282 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17283 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17284 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17287 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17288 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17289 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17292 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17293 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17294 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17295 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17296 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17297 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17298 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17299 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17300 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17301 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17303 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17304 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17308 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17309 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17310 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17311 the availability thereof is advertised in
17312 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17313 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17316 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17317 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17318 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17319 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17323 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17324 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17325 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17329 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17330 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17331 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17332 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17333 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17334 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17335 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17336 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17337 arrival of the message.
17339 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17340 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17341 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17342 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17343 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17345 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17346 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17347 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17348 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17349 automatically deleted.
17351 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17352 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17353 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17354 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17355 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17356 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17357 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17358 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17359 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17362 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17363 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17364 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17365 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17366 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17367 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17368 &$primary_hostname$&.
17370 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17371 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17372 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17373 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17374 as failures in the configuration file.
17376 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17377 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17379 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17380 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17381 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17382 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17383 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17384 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17387 The following variables will not have useful values:
17389 $max_received_linelength
17394 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17395 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17396 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17397 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17399 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17400 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17401 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17403 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17404 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17405 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17406 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17408 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17409 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17410 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17411 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17412 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17413 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17415 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17416 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17417 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17418 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17419 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17420 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17421 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17424 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17425 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17426 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17427 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17428 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17429 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17430 domain causes a syntax error.
17431 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17435 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17436 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17437 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17438 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17439 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17440 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17441 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17442 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17443 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17444 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17445 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17446 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17449 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17450 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17451 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17452 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17453 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17454 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17455 details of Exim's logging.
17458 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17459 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17460 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17461 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17462 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17463 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17464 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17468 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17469 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17470 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17471 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17472 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17476 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17477 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17478 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17479 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17480 details of Exim's logging.
17483 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17484 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17485 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17486 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17487 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17488 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17489 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17490 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17491 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17492 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17493 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17494 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17497 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17498 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17499 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17500 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17501 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17502 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17505 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17506 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17507 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17508 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17509 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17511 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17512 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17513 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17514 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17515 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17517 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17518 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17519 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17520 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17521 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17522 contains the pipe command.
17525 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17526 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17527 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17528 is used in a system filter.
17531 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17532 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17533 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17534 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17535 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17536 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17537 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17538 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17539 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17540 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17542 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17543 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17544 transport option overrides.
17547 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17548 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17549 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17550 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17551 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17552 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17553 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17554 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17555 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17556 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17557 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17558 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17562 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17563 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17564 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17565 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17566 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17567 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17568 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17569 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17570 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17571 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17573 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17574 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17575 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17578 .option timezone main string unset
17579 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17580 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17581 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17582 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17583 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17584 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17588 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17589 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17590 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17591 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17592 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17593 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17596 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17597 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17598 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17599 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17600 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17601 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17602 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17603 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17604 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17605 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17606 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17609 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17610 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17611 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17612 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17613 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17615 The server's private key is also
17616 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17617 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17619 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17620 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17621 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17622 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17624 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17625 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17627 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17628 when a list of more than one
17629 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17631 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17632 when a list of more than one file is used.
17634 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17635 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17636 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17637 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17639 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17640 generated for every connection.
17642 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17643 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17644 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17645 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17646 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17648 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17650 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17651 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17652 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17654 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17657 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17658 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17659 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17660 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17661 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17662 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17664 The value must be at least 1024.
17666 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17667 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17668 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17670 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17673 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17674 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17675 larger prime than requested.
17678 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17679 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17680 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17681 to be used by Exim.
17683 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17684 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17685 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17686 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17688 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17689 then it names a file from which DH
17690 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17691 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17692 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17693 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17694 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17695 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17697 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17700 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17701 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17702 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17703 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17705 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17706 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17708 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17709 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17710 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17712 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17713 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17714 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17715 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17716 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17718 The available standard primes are:
17719 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17720 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17721 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17722 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17724 The available additional primes are:
17725 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17727 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17728 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17729 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17730 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17731 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17733 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17734 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17735 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17737 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17738 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17739 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17740 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17741 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17744 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17745 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17746 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17747 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17748 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17749 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17750 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17753 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17754 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17755 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17756 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17758 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17759 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17760 for valid selections.
17762 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17763 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17764 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17766 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17769 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17770 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17771 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17773 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17774 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17775 Certificate Authority.
17777 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17779 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17780 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17781 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17784 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17787 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17788 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17789 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17790 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17794 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17795 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17796 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17797 files which contains the server's private keys.
17798 If this option is unset, or if
17799 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17800 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17801 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17803 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17806 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17807 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17808 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17809 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17810 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17811 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17815 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17816 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17817 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17818 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17819 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17820 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17821 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17822 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17823 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17824 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17825 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17828 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17829 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17830 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17831 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17834 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17835 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17836 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17837 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17839 or the absolute path to
17840 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17841 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17843 The "system" value for the option will use a
17844 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17845 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17846 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17849 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17850 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17852 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17854 either by file or directory
17855 are added to those given by the system default location.
17857 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17858 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17859 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17860 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17861 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17862 use the explicit directory version.
17864 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17866 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17870 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17871 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17872 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17873 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17874 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17875 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17876 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17877 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17879 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17880 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17881 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17882 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17883 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17884 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17885 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17887 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17888 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17889 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17890 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17891 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17892 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17893 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17896 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17900 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17901 .cindex "trusted groups"
17902 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17903 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17904 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17905 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17906 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17907 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17908 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17911 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17912 .cindex "trusted users"
17913 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17914 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17915 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17916 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17917 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17918 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17919 Exim user are trusted.
17921 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17922 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17923 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17924 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17925 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17926 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17927 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17928 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17929 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17932 .option unknown_username main string unset
17933 See &%unknown_login%&.
17935 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17936 .cindex "trusted users"
17937 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17938 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17939 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17940 .cindex "envelope from"
17941 .cindex "envelope sender"
17942 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17943 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17944 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17945 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17946 is used) is ignored.
17948 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17949 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17951 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17953 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17954 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17955 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17956 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17957 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17958 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17959 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17960 followed by a hyphen
17961 by a setting like this:
17963 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17965 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17966 restriction, you can use
17968 untrusted_set_sender = *
17970 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17971 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17972 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17973 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17974 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17975 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17976 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17977 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17979 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17980 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17981 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17982 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17986 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17987 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17988 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17989 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17990 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17991 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17992 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17993 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17994 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17995 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17997 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17998 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18000 The pattern can be seen by running
18002 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18004 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18005 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18006 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18007 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18008 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18009 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18012 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18013 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18016 .option warn_message_file main string unset
18017 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18018 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18019 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18020 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18021 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18022 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18023 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18026 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18027 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18028 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18029 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18030 .ecindex IIDconfima
18031 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18036 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18037 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18039 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18040 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18041 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18042 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18043 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
18045 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18046 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18047 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18048 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18049 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18053 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18054 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18055 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18056 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18057 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18058 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18059 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18061 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18062 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18063 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18064 routers, and the eventual transport.
18066 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18067 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18068 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18069 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18070 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18072 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18073 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18074 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18075 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18076 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18078 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18079 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18080 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18082 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18084 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18086 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18088 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18089 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18092 See also the &%set%& option below.
18095 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18096 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18097 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18098 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18099 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18100 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18101 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18105 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18107 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18108 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18109 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18110 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18111 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18116 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18117 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18118 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18119 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18120 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18121 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18122 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18123 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18124 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18125 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18128 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18130 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18133 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18135 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18136 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18137 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18138 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18141 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18142 .cindex "case of local parts"
18143 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18144 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18145 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18146 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18147 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18148 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18149 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18152 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18153 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18154 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18155 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18156 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18157 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18158 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18159 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18160 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18162 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18163 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18164 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18165 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18169 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18170 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18171 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18172 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18174 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18175 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18176 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18177 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18178 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18179 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18180 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18181 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18182 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18183 the router is skipped.
18185 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18186 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18187 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18188 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18189 setting to achieve this. For example:
18191 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18193 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18194 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18195 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18199 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18200 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18201 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18202 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18203 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18204 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18205 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18206 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18208 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18209 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18211 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18212 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18214 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18215 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18216 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18218 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18220 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18222 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18225 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18227 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18228 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18232 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18233 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18234 be specified using &%condition%&.
18236 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18237 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18238 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18239 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18240 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18241 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18242 Router rules processing behavior.
18244 This is best illustrated in an example:
18246 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18247 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18249 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18252 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18255 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18256 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18257 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18258 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18259 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18260 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18261 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18262 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18264 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18265 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18266 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18267 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18270 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18271 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18272 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18273 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18274 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18277 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18278 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18279 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18280 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18281 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18282 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18283 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18284 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18285 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18286 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18287 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18288 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18289 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18290 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18294 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18295 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18296 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18297 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18298 transport option of the same name.
18300 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18301 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18302 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18303 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18304 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18305 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18306 the dnssec request bit set.
18307 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18309 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18310 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18311 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18312 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18313 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18314 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18315 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18316 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18317 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18320 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18321 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18322 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18323 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18324 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18325 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18326 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18327 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18331 .option driver routers string unset
18332 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18336 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18337 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18338 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18339 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18340 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18341 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18342 Not effective on redirect routers.
18346 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18347 .cindex "envelope from"
18348 .cindex "envelope sender"
18349 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18350 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18351 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18352 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18353 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18354 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18355 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18357 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18358 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18359 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18362 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18363 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18364 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18365 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18367 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18368 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18369 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18370 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18376 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18377 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18378 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18379 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18380 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18382 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18383 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18384 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18385 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18386 setting &%return_path%&.
18388 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18389 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18390 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18394 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18395 .cindex "address" "testing"
18396 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18397 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18398 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18399 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18400 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18401 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18402 on for the system alias file.
18403 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18406 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18407 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18408 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18412 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18413 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18414 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18415 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18419 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18420 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18421 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18425 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18426 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18427 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18431 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18432 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18433 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18434 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18435 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18436 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18437 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18438 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18439 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18441 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18442 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18443 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18444 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18445 transport for further details.
18448 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18449 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18450 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18451 .cindex "transport" "local"
18452 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18453 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18454 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18456 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18457 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18458 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18459 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18460 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18464 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18465 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18466 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18467 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18468 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18469 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18470 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18471 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18472 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18473 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18474 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18475 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18476 &"see"& the added header lines.
18478 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18479 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18480 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18481 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18483 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18484 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18486 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18487 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18489 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18490 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18491 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18492 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18493 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18494 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18495 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18496 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18497 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18498 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18502 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18503 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18504 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18505 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18506 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18507 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18508 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18509 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18510 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18511 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18512 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18513 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18514 &"see"& the original header lines.
18516 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18517 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18518 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18521 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18522 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18524 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18525 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18527 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18528 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18529 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18530 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18532 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18533 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18534 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18538 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18539 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18540 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18541 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18542 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18543 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18544 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18547 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18551 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18553 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18554 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18555 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18556 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18557 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18558 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18560 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18561 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18563 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18564 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18566 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18567 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18569 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18570 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18571 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18572 domain that is being routed.
18574 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18575 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18578 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18579 .cindex "additional groups"
18580 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18581 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18582 .cindex "transport" "local"
18583 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18584 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18585 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18586 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18587 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18591 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18592 .cindex affix "router precondition"
18593 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18594 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18595 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18596 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18597 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18600 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18601 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18602 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18603 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18604 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18605 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18606 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18607 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18608 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18610 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18611 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18612 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18613 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18614 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18615 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18616 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18617 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18618 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18619 the relevant transport.
18621 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18622 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18623 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18626 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18627 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18628 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18629 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18630 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18634 local_part_prefix = real-
18636 transport = local_delivery
18638 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18639 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18641 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18642 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18645 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18646 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18647 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18648 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18651 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18652 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18656 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18657 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18658 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18659 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18660 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18661 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18662 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18663 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18664 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18668 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18669 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18673 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18674 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18675 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18676 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18677 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18679 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18680 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18683 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18685 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18686 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18687 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18688 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18689 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18690 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18691 each virtual domain:
18695 local_parts = postmaster
18696 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18700 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18701 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18702 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18703 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18704 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18705 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18706 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18707 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18708 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18709 redirect addresses.
18713 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18714 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18715 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18716 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18717 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18718 delivery to be deferred.
18720 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18721 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18723 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18724 means of the setting
18728 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18729 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18730 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18732 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18733 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18734 controls what happens next.
18737 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18738 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18739 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18740 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18741 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18742 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18743 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18744 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18746 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18747 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18748 applies to all of them.
18752 .option pass_router routers string unset
18753 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18754 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18755 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18756 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18757 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18758 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18759 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18760 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18761 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18762 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18766 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18767 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18768 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18769 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18770 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18771 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18773 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18774 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18775 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18776 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18780 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18781 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18782 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18783 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18784 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18785 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18786 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18788 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18789 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18790 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18791 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18792 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18794 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18795 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18796 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18797 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18798 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18801 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18802 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18805 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18806 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18807 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18808 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18809 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18810 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18811 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18812 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18814 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18815 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18816 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18817 operates as follows:
18819 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18820 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18821 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18822 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18825 require_files = mail:/some/file
18826 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18828 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18829 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18831 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18832 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18833 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18834 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18836 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18837 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18838 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18839 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18840 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18842 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18843 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18844 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18845 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18846 check again in that process.
18848 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18849 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18850 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18851 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18852 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18853 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18854 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18856 require_files = +/some/file
18858 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18859 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18860 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18864 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18865 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18866 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18867 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18868 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18869 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18870 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18871 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18874 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18875 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18876 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18877 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18878 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18881 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18882 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18883 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18887 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18888 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18889 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18891 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18892 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18893 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18894 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18895 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18896 cause the router to defer.
18898 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18899 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18901 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18903 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18904 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18906 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18907 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18908 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18909 of these values that is set:
18912 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18914 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18916 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18918 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18921 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18922 router, but not for the transport.
18926 .option self routers string freeze
18927 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18928 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18929 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18930 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18931 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18932 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18934 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18935 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18936 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18937 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18938 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18940 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18941 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18942 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18943 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18944 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18949 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18951 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18952 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18953 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18954 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18956 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18957 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18958 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18963 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18964 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18965 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18966 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18967 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18968 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18974 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18975 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18976 be passed to the next router.
18979 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18982 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18983 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18984 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18985 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18986 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18987 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18992 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18993 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18994 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18995 address matches something on the list.
18996 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18999 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19000 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19001 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19002 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19003 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19004 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19005 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19010 .option set routers "string list" unset
19011 .cindex router variables
19012 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19013 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19014 The list separator is a colon but can be changed in the
19017 Each list-element given must be of the form $"name = value"$
19018 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19019 Values containing colons should either have them doubled, or
19020 the entire list should be prefixed with a list-separator change.
19021 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19022 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19024 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19025 The variables can be used by the router options
19026 (not including any preconditions)
19027 and by the transport.
19028 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19029 Varible use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19031 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19032 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19036 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19037 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19038 .cindex "packet radio"
19039 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19040 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19041 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19042 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19043 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19044 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19045 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19046 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19048 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19049 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19050 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19051 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19052 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19053 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19054 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19055 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19056 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19057 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19059 translate_ip_address = \
19060 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19063 The file would contain lines like
19065 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
19066 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19068 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19073 .option transport routers string&!! unset
19074 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19075 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19076 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19077 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19078 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19079 delivery is deferred.
19081 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19082 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19083 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19087 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19088 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19089 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19090 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19091 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19092 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19093 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19094 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19095 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19096 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19097 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19103 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19104 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19105 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19106 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19107 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19108 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19109 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19110 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19111 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19112 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19114 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19115 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19116 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19117 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19118 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19120 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19126 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19127 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19128 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19129 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19130 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19131 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19132 delivery to be deferred.
19134 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19135 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19136 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19137 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19138 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19139 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19141 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19142 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19143 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19144 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19145 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19146 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19147 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19148 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19150 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19151 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19152 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19153 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19154 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19155 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19156 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19157 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19158 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19159 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19161 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19162 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19163 subsequent routers.
19166 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19167 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19168 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19169 .cindex "transport" "local"
19170 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19171 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19172 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19173 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19174 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19175 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19176 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19177 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19178 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19179 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19180 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19181 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19185 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19186 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19187 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19190 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19191 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19193 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19194 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19195 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19196 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19197 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19198 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19199 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19201 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19202 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19203 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19207 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19208 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19210 delivering in cutthrough mode
19211 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19212 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19214 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19217 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19218 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19219 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19220 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19222 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19223 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19224 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19231 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19232 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19234 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19235 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19236 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19237 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19238 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19239 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19240 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19241 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19242 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19246 domains = mydomain.example
19248 transport = local_delivery
19250 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19251 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19252 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19253 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19260 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19261 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19263 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19264 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19265 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19266 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19267 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19268 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19270 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19271 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19272 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19273 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19276 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19277 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19278 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19279 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19280 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19281 generic option, the router declines.
19283 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19284 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19285 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19287 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19288 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19289 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19290 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19291 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19292 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19295 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19296 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19297 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19298 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19299 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19300 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19302 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19303 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19304 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19305 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19306 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19307 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19308 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19309 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19310 case routing fails.
19313 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19314 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19315 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19316 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19317 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19319 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19320 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19322 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19324 The domain does not exist in DNS
19326 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19327 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19328 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19330 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19332 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19334 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19335 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19337 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19338 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19340 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19341 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19343 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19344 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19350 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19351 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19352 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19354 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19355 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19356 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19357 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19358 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19359 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19360 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19363 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19364 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19365 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19366 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19367 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19368 required. For example,
19372 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19373 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19374 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19375 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19376 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19379 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19380 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19381 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19382 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19383 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19384 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19386 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19387 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19388 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19389 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19390 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19391 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19392 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19393 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19395 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19396 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19401 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19402 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19403 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19404 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19405 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19406 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19407 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19408 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19412 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19413 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19414 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19415 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19416 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19417 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19418 only A records are used.
19420 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19421 .cindex IPv4 preference
19422 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19423 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19424 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19425 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19426 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19428 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19429 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19430 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19431 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19432 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19433 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19434 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19437 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19439 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19440 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19441 the address record.
19444 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19445 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19446 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19447 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19452 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19453 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19454 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19455 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19456 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19457 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19458 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19459 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19460 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19465 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19466 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19467 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19468 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19469 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19470 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19471 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19472 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19473 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19474 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19475 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19477 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19478 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19481 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19482 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19483 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19484 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19485 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19489 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19490 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19491 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19492 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19493 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19494 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19495 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19496 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19498 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19499 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19500 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19501 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19502 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19503 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19504 without processing them independently,
19505 provided the following conditions are met:
19508 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19509 &%headers_remove%&.
19511 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19518 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19519 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19520 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19521 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19522 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19523 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19524 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19525 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19526 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19527 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19529 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19530 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19535 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19536 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19537 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19538 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19543 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19544 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19545 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19546 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19549 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19551 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19552 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19553 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19554 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19555 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19556 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19559 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19560 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19561 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19562 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19563 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19565 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19566 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19567 such as that implied by
19571 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19572 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19573 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19574 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19584 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19585 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19587 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19588 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19589 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19590 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19591 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19592 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19593 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19594 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19595 router handles the address
19599 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19600 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19601 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19603 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19605 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19606 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19608 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19609 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19610 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19611 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19613 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19614 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19615 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19616 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19620 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19621 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19623 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19624 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19625 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19626 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19627 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19628 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19631 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19633 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19635 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19636 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19637 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19638 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19639 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19640 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19641 must not be specified for it.
19643 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19644 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19645 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19646 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19647 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19648 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19649 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19652 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19653 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19654 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19655 delivery to the address is deferred.
19658 .option port iplookup integer 0
19659 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19660 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19664 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19665 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19666 protocols is to be used.
19669 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19670 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19673 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19675 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19676 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19679 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19680 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19681 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19682 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19683 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19684 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19685 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19686 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19689 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19690 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19691 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19692 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19693 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19694 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19695 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19696 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19697 following could be used:
19699 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19700 reroute = $local_part@$1
19703 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19704 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19705 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19706 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19711 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19714 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19715 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19716 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19717 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19718 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19719 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19720 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19721 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19722 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19723 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19725 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19726 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19727 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19728 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19729 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19730 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19731 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19734 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19735 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19736 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19737 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19738 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19739 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19740 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19743 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19744 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19745 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19746 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19747 below, following the list of private options.
19750 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19752 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19753 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19755 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19756 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19758 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19759 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19760 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19761 of the following values:
19770 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19771 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19772 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19775 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19776 router only if &%more%& is true.
19778 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19779 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19780 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19781 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19783 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19784 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19785 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19788 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19789 .cindex "randomized host list"
19790 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19791 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19792 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19793 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19794 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19795 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19796 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19797 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19799 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19800 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19801 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19802 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19804 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19806 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19807 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19808 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19809 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19810 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19813 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19814 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19815 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19818 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19820 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19821 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19825 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19826 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19827 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19828 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19831 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19832 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19833 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19834 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19835 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19836 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19837 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19838 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19840 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19841 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19842 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19843 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19844 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19845 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19846 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19847 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19852 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19853 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19854 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19855 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19856 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19857 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19859 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19861 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19865 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19866 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19868 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19869 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19870 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19871 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19872 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19873 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19874 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19875 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19876 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19877 in a &%route_list%&).
19879 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19880 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19881 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19882 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19886 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19887 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19888 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19889 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19890 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19891 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19892 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19895 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19896 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19898 This data can be accessed by setting
19900 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19902 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19903 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19904 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19905 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19906 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19911 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19912 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19913 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19914 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19915 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
19916 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
19917 The format of each item
19918 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19919 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
19921 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19922 variables are set during its expansion:
19925 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19926 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19927 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19929 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19932 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19934 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19937 .vindex "&$value$&"
19938 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19939 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19941 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19945 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19946 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19950 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19951 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19952 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19953 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19954 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19955 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19958 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19959 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19960 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19962 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19963 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19966 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19967 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19968 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19969 number follows. For example:
19971 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19975 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19976 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19977 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19978 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19979 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19982 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19983 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19984 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19985 records in the DNS. For example:
19987 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19989 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19992 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19994 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19995 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19996 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19997 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19998 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19999 happens is controlled by the
20000 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20001 &%self%& option of the router.
20003 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20004 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20005 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20006 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20007 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20008 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20009 defined by MX preferences.
20011 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20012 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20013 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20015 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20016 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20017 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20018 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20020 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20021 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20024 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20025 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20026 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20028 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20029 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20033 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20034 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20035 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20036 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20037 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20038 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20039 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20042 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20043 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20045 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20046 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20048 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20049 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20050 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20052 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20053 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20054 timeout), delivery is deferred.
20056 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20058 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20063 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20064 domain2 host4:host5
20066 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20067 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20068 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20069 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20072 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20073 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20074 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20075 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20078 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20079 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20084 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20085 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20088 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20089 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20093 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20094 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20095 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20098 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20099 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20100 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20101 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20103 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20105 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20106 your first router something like this:
20109 driver = manualroute
20110 domains = !+local_domains
20111 transport = remote_smtp
20112 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20114 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20115 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20116 they are tried in order
20117 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20118 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20121 driver = manualroute
20122 transport = remote_smtp
20123 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20125 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20126 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20127 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20128 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20129 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20130 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20131 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20132 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20135 .cindex "mail hub example"
20136 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20137 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20138 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20139 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20140 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20141 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20142 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20143 lookup is easier to manage.
20145 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20146 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20150 driver = manualroute
20151 transport = remote_smtp
20152 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20154 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20155 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20156 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20157 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20158 domain can be used to find the host:
20161 driver = manualroute
20162 transport = remote_smtp
20163 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20165 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20166 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20167 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20171 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20172 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20173 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20174 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20175 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20176 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20179 driver = manualroute
20180 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20181 route_list = saved.domain.example
20183 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20184 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20185 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20188 driver = manualroute
20190 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20191 *.saved.domain2.example \
20192 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20195 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20197 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20198 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20199 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20200 the address if the lookup fails.
20203 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20204 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20205 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20206 one way it can be done:
20212 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20213 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20214 return_fail_output = true
20219 driver = manualroute
20221 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20223 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20225 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20227 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20228 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20229 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20231 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20232 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20241 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20242 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20244 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20245 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20246 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20247 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20248 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20249 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20250 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20251 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20252 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20253 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20255 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20257 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20258 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20259 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20260 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20261 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20264 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
20265 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20266 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20267 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20268 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20269 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20272 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
20273 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20274 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20275 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20276 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20277 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20278 not set, a value for the gid also.
20280 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20281 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20282 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20283 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20284 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20285 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20289 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
20290 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20291 before running the command.
20294 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20295 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20296 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20300 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20301 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20302 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20303 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20304 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20307 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20310 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20311 &%no_more%& is set.
20313 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20314 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20315 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20316 included in the SMTP response.
20318 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20319 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20320 included in any SMTP response.
20322 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20324 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20325 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20327 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20328 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20329 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20332 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20333 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20336 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20337 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20339 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20340 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20341 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20342 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20344 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20345 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20346 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20347 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20348 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20350 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20351 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20352 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20353 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20354 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20356 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20357 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20358 variable. For example, this return line
20360 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20362 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20363 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20364 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20365 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20370 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20371 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20373 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20374 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20375 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20376 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20377 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20378 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20379 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20380 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20381 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20382 redirected in several different ways:
20385 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20388 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20390 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20392 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20394 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20396 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20398 It can be discarded.
20401 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20402 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20403 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20404 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20406 If success DSNs have been requested
20407 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20408 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20409 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20413 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20414 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20415 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20416 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20417 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20418 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20422 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20424 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20425 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20426 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20427 cause delivery to be deferred.
20429 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20430 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20435 file = $home/.forward
20438 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20439 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20440 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20441 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20446 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20447 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20448 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20449 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20452 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20453 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20454 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20455 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20457 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20458 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20459 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20460 saves some resources.
20468 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20469 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20470 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20471 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20472 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20475 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20476 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20477 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20478 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20479 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20480 document is intended for use by end users.
20482 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20483 described in the next section.
20486 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20487 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20488 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20489 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20490 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20494 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20495 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20496 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20497 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20498 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20499 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20500 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20501 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20502 commas or newlines.
20503 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20506 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20507 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20508 next newline character is ignored.
20510 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20511 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20512 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20513 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20516 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20517 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20518 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20519 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20520 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20521 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20524 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20528 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20529 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20530 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20531 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20532 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20533 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20534 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20535 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20536 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20537 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20538 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20540 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20541 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20542 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20543 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20544 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20546 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20548 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20549 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20550 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20551 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20552 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20555 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20556 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20557 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20558 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20559 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20561 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20562 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20567 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20568 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20571 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20573 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20574 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20575 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20576 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20577 should really contain
20579 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20581 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20582 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20583 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20587 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20588 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20589 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20592 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20593 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20594 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20595 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20596 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20597 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20598 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20600 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20601 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20602 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20603 in double quotes, for example:
20605 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20607 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20608 quote just the command. An item such as
20610 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20612 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20614 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20615 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20616 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20617 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20618 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20619 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20620 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20621 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20622 an &%accept%& router.
20625 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20626 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20627 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20628 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20630 /home/world/minbari
20632 is treated as a filename, but
20634 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20636 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20637 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20638 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20639 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20641 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20642 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20644 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20645 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20646 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20647 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20650 .cindex "included address list"
20651 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20652 If an item is of the form
20654 :include:<path name>
20656 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20657 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20658 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20659 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20660 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20661 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20663 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20665 It must be given as
20667 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20670 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20671 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20672 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20673 .cindex "black hole"
20674 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20675 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20676 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20677 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20681 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20682 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20683 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20685 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20686 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20687 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20688 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20692 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20693 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20694 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20695 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20696 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20697 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20698 redirection items of the form
20703 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20704 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20705 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20706 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20708 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20710 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20712 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20713 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20715 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20716 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20717 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20719 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20720 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20721 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20722 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20723 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20724 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20725 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20726 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20727 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20730 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20731 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20732 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20733 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20735 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20736 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20737 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20738 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20739 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20741 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20742 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20743 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20744 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20745 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20749 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20750 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20751 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20752 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20753 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20754 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20755 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20759 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20760 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20761 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20762 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20763 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20764 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20765 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20766 aliasing scheme of the type
20768 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20772 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20773 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20774 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20777 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20778 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20780 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20781 the pipes are distinct.
20785 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20786 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20787 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20788 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20789 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20790 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20791 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20792 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20793 can be used to avoid this.
20796 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20797 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20798 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20799 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20800 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20801 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20802 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20806 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20808 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20809 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20812 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20813 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20814 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20817 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20818 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20819 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20820 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20823 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20824 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20825 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20826 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20827 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20828 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20829 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20831 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20832 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20835 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20836 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20837 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20838 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20839 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20843 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20844 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20845 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20846 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20847 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20848 let ordinary users do.
20852 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20853 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20854 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20855 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20856 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20857 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20859 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20860 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20861 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20862 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20863 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20864 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20866 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20868 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20869 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20870 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20871 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20872 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20873 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20874 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20875 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20878 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20879 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20880 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20881 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20882 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20883 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20884 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20885 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20889 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20890 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20891 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20892 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20893 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20894 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20897 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20898 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20899 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20900 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20901 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20902 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20904 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20905 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20906 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20908 data = #Exim filter\n\
20909 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20911 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20912 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20913 choice into a newline.
20916 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20917 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20918 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20919 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20920 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20923 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20924 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20925 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20926 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20927 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20928 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20929 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20930 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20932 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20933 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20934 runs a check on the containing directory,
20935 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20936 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20937 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20938 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20939 not, the router declines.
20942 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20943 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20944 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20945 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20946 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20947 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20948 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
20951 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20952 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20953 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20954 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20955 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20958 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20959 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20960 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20961 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20965 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20966 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20967 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20968 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20969 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20974 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20975 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20976 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20977 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20978 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20979 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20980 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20981 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20982 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20983 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20984 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20987 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20988 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20989 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20990 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20991 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20994 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20995 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20996 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20997 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20998 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20999 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21001 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21002 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21003 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21004 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21005 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21006 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21007 &_.forward_& files).
21010 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21011 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21012 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21013 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21014 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21017 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21018 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21019 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21020 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21021 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21022 of the embedded Perl support.
21025 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21026 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21027 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21028 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21029 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21032 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21033 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21034 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21035 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21036 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21039 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21040 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21041 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21042 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21043 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21044 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21045 &%one_time%& is set.
21048 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21049 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21050 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21051 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21052 to make use of &%run%& items.
21055 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21056 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21057 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21058 If this option is true, items of the form
21060 :include:<path name>
21062 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21065 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21066 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21067 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21068 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21069 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21070 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21071 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21074 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21075 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21076 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21077 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21078 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21081 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21082 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21083 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21084 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21085 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21090 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21091 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21092 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21093 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21094 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21095 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21096 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21099 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21101 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21102 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21103 file did not exist.
21106 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21108 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21109 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21110 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21112 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21113 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21114 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21115 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21116 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21117 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21118 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21119 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21123 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21124 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21125 redirection list must start with this directory.
21128 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21129 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21130 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21133 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21134 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21135 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21136 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21137 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21138 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21139 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21140 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21141 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21142 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21143 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21144 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21145 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21146 before they subscribed.
21148 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21149 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21150 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21151 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21154 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21155 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21156 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21157 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21159 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21160 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21161 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21163 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21166 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21167 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21168 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21169 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21170 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21174 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21175 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21176 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21177 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21178 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21179 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21180 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21181 See &%check_owner%& above.
21184 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21185 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21186 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21187 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21190 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21191 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21192 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21193 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21194 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21195 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21196 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21199 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21200 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21201 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21202 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21203 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21204 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21205 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21206 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21208 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21209 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21210 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21213 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21214 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21215 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21216 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21217 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21218 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21219 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21220 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21221 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21222 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21225 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21226 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21227 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21228 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21229 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21230 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21233 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21234 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21235 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21236 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21237 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21238 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21241 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21242 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21243 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21244 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21245 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21248 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21249 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21250 :subaddress part of an address.
21252 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21253 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21254 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21255 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21258 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21259 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21260 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21261 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21262 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21263 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21264 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21268 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21269 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
21270 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21271 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
21272 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21273 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21274 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21275 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21276 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21277 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21278 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21279 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21280 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21281 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21282 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21283 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21285 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21286 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21287 the following routers.
21289 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21290 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21291 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21292 so it is passed to the following routers.
21294 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21295 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21296 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21297 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21299 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21300 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21301 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21302 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21308 file = $home/.forward
21309 file_transport = address_file
21310 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21311 reply_transport = address_reply
21314 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21315 syntax_errors_text = \
21316 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21317 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21318 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21319 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21320 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21321 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21322 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21323 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21324 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21325 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21327 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21328 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21329 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21334 local_part_prefix = real-
21335 transport = local_delivery
21337 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21338 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21340 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21341 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21345 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21346 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21349 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21350 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21351 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21352 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21359 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21360 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21362 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21363 "Environment for local transports"
21364 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21365 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21366 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21367 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21368 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21369 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21370 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21372 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21373 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21374 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21375 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21377 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21378 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21379 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21380 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21381 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21385 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21386 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21387 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21388 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21389 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21390 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21391 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21394 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21395 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21399 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21401 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21402 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21403 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21404 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21409 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21410 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21411 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21412 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21413 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21414 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21415 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21416 group (set by the transport). For example:
21419 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21423 transport = group_delivery
21426 # This transport overrides the group
21428 driver = appendfile
21429 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21432 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21433 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21434 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21437 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21438 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21439 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21440 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21441 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21442 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21444 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21445 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21446 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21447 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21448 original gid is also used.
21450 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21451 following that is set is used:
21454 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21456 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21458 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21459 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21461 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21463 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21464 the uid is the creator's uid;
21466 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21469 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21470 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21471 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21472 The first of the following that is set is used:
21475 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21477 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21479 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21481 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21486 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21487 &%never_users%& list.
21493 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21494 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21495 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21496 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21497 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21498 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21499 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21500 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21501 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21502 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21505 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21507 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21509 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21511 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21514 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21517 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21519 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21523 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21524 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21525 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21529 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21530 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21531 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21532 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21533 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21534 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21535 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21536 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21537 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21538 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21539 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21540 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21541 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21542 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21551 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21553 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21554 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21555 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21556 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21557 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21560 .option body_only transports boolean false
21561 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21562 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21563 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21564 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21565 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21566 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21567 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21568 automatically suppress them.
21571 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21572 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21573 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21574 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21575 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21576 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21579 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21580 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21581 deliveries by the transport or for any
21582 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21583 what you are doing.
21586 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21587 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21588 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21589 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21591 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21592 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21593 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21594 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21595 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21596 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21598 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21599 transport and the router that called it.
21601 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21602 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21603 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21604 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21605 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21606 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21607 safely be resent to other recipients.
21610 .option driver transports string unset
21611 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21612 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21615 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21616 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21617 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21618 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21619 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21620 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21621 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21622 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21623 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21624 resent to other recipients.
21627 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21629 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21630 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21633 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21634 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21635 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21636 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21637 &%user%& (see below).
21640 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21641 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21642 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21643 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21644 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21645 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21646 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21647 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21648 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21649 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21650 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21652 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21653 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21656 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21657 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21658 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21659 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21660 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21661 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21662 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21663 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21666 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21667 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21668 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21669 This option specifies a list of header names,
21670 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21671 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21672 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21674 Each list item is separately expanded.
21675 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21676 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21677 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21679 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21680 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21682 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21683 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21684 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21688 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21689 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21690 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21691 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21692 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21693 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21694 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21695 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21698 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21701 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21702 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21703 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21704 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21705 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21706 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21707 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21708 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21709 change envelope recipients at this time.
21712 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21713 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21715 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21716 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21717 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21718 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21719 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21720 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21721 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21725 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21726 .cindex "additional groups"
21727 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21728 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21729 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21730 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21731 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21734 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21735 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21736 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21737 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21738 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21739 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21740 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21741 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21743 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21744 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21745 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21746 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21747 Obviously there is scope for
21748 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21749 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21751 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21752 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21753 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21754 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21755 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21758 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21759 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21760 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21761 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21762 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21763 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21764 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21765 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21766 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21767 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21768 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21769 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21770 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21775 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21776 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21777 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21778 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21779 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21780 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21781 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21782 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21785 local_part_prefix = *-
21787 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21790 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21792 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21793 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21794 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21795 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21796 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21799 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21800 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21801 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21802 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21803 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21804 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21805 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21806 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21807 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21809 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21810 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21811 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21812 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21814 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21815 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21816 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21819 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21820 .cindex "envelope sender"
21821 .cindex "envelope from"
21822 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21823 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21824 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21825 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21826 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21827 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21828 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21829 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21830 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21832 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21833 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21835 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21836 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21837 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21838 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21839 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21840 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21841 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21843 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21844 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21845 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21846 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21847 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21851 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21852 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21853 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21854 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21855 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21856 have easy access to it.
21858 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21859 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21860 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21861 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21862 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21866 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21867 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21870 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21871 .cindex "shadow transport"
21872 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21873 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21874 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21876 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21877 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21878 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21879 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21880 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21881 cause a log line to be written.
21883 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21884 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21885 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21886 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21887 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21890 ST=<shadow transport name>
21892 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21893 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21894 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21895 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21896 headers that some sites insist on.
21899 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21900 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21901 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21902 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21903 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21904 individual users or via a system filter.
21905 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21907 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21908 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21909 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21910 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21911 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21913 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21914 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21915 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21916 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21917 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21918 &(pipe)& transports.
21920 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21921 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21922 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21923 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21924 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21926 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21927 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21928 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21929 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21931 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21932 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21933 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21934 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21935 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21936 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21938 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21939 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21940 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21941 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21942 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21943 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21944 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21945 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21947 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21948 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21949 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21950 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21951 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21952 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21953 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21954 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21955 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21956 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21959 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21960 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21961 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21962 which the message is being sent. For example:
21964 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21965 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21968 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21969 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21970 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21972 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21973 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21974 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21977 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21979 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21980 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21981 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21982 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21983 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21984 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21986 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21987 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21988 arguments. Consider this example:
21990 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21991 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21993 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21994 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21996 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21997 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22001 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22002 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22003 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22004 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22005 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22006 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22007 bounced from a transport filter.
22009 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22010 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22011 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22014 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22015 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22016 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22017 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22018 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22019 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22020 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22021 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22022 becomes a temporary error.
22025 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22026 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22027 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22028 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22029 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22030 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22031 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22034 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22035 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22036 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22038 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22039 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22040 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22041 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22043 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22044 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22045 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22052 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22053 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22055 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22057 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22058 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22059 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22060 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22061 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22062 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22063 copy of the message is delivered each time.
22065 .cindex "batched local delivery"
22066 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22067 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22068 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22069 local transport, for example:
22072 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22073 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22074 recipients saves space.
22076 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22077 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22079 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22080 to a scanner program or
22081 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22085 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22086 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22087 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22089 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22090 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22091 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22092 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22093 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22094 to certain conditions:
22097 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22098 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22099 batching is possible.
22101 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22102 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22103 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22105 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22106 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22107 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22108 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22109 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22112 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22113 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22114 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22118 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22119 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22120 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22121 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22122 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22123 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22124 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22127 escape_string = ".."
22129 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22130 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22131 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22133 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22134 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22135 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22136 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22137 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22138 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22140 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22141 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22142 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22143 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22144 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22145 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22146 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22147 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22148 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22153 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22156 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22157 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22158 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22159 .cindex "directory creation"
22160 .cindex "creating directories"
22161 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22162 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22163 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22164 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22165 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22166 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22167 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22168 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22169 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22170 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22172 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22173 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22174 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22177 .cindex "quota" "system"
22178 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22179 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22180 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22182 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22183 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22184 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22185 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22187 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22188 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22191 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22192 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22193 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22194 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22199 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22200 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22201 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22202 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22203 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22205 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22206 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22207 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22208 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22209 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22210 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22211 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22212 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22213 operation. There are two cases:
22216 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22217 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22218 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22219 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22220 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22221 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22222 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22224 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22225 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22226 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22230 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22231 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22232 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22233 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22238 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22240 require "fileinto";
22241 fileinto "folder23";
22243 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22244 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22245 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22246 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22247 way of handling this requirement:
22249 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22250 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22251 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22253 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22257 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22258 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22259 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22261 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22262 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22263 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22264 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22265 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22266 path to the transport.
22268 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22269 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22274 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22275 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22279 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22280 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22281 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22282 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22283 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22284 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22285 delivery is deferred.
22288 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22289 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22290 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22291 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22292 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22293 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22294 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22295 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22298 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22299 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22300 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22301 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22305 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22306 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22309 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22310 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22311 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22312 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22313 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22316 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22317 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22318 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22319 process is running.
22322 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22323 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22324 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22325 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22326 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22327 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22328 contains is significant.
22330 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22331 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22332 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22333 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22334 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22336 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22337 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22338 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22339 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22340 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22341 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22343 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22344 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22345 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22346 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22348 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22349 .cindex "directory creation"
22350 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22351 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22352 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22354 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22355 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22356 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22357 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22358 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22362 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22363 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22364 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22365 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22366 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22369 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22370 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22371 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22372 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22373 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22374 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22375 &%file_must_exist%&.
22378 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22379 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22380 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22381 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22383 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22384 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22385 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22386 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22387 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22390 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22392 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22393 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22394 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22395 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22397 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22399 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22400 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22404 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22405 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22406 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22409 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22410 See &%check_string%& above.
22413 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
22414 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22415 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22416 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22417 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22418 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22421 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22422 .cindex "locking files"
22423 .cindex "lock files"
22424 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22425 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22427 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22428 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22431 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22432 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22435 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22436 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22437 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22438 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22439 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22440 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22444 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22445 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22446 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22447 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22448 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22449 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22450 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22451 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22452 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22455 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22456 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22458 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22459 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22460 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22461 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22462 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22463 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22464 delivery is deferred.
22467 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22468 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22469 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22470 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22473 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22474 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22475 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22476 .cindex "locking files"
22477 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22478 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22479 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22480 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22481 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22482 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22483 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22484 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22486 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22487 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22488 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22489 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22491 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22492 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22495 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22497 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22498 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22499 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22501 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22502 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22504 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22507 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22508 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22509 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22510 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22513 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22514 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22515 for details of locking.
22518 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22519 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22520 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22523 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22524 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22525 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22528 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22529 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22530 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22531 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22532 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22535 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22536 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22537 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22538 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22539 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22540 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22541 external source that maintains the data.
22544 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22545 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22546 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22547 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22548 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22549 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22550 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22551 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22555 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22556 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22557 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22558 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22559 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22560 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22561 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22562 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22563 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22564 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22567 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22568 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22569 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22570 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22571 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22572 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22573 calculation. The default value is:
22575 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22577 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22578 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22580 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22582 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22584 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22585 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22586 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22587 directly into that directory.
22590 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22591 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22592 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22595 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22596 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22597 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22600 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22601 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22602 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22603 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22604 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22605 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22606 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22607 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22609 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22610 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22611 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22612 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22613 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22614 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22615 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22616 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22617 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22618 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22621 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22622 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22623 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22624 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22625 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22626 below for further details.
22629 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22630 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22631 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22634 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22635 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22636 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22639 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22640 .cindex "locking files"
22641 .cindex "file" "locking"
22642 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22643 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22644 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22645 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22646 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22647 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22648 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22650 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22651 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22652 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22659 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22660 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22661 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22662 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22663 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22664 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22665 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22666 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22668 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22669 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22670 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22671 append messages to it.
22674 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22675 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22676 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22677 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22678 in which case it is:
22680 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22681 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22683 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22684 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22686 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22687 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22688 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22689 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22694 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22695 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22697 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22698 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22699 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22700 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22701 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22702 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22703 value, and this option is ignored.
22706 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22707 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22708 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22709 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22710 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22713 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22714 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22715 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22716 on users about incoming mail.
22719 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22720 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22721 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22722 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22723 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22724 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22725 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22726 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22727 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22729 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22730 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22731 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22733 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22734 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22735 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22736 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22737 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22738 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22740 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22741 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22742 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22743 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22744 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22747 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22748 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22750 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22752 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22753 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22754 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22755 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22756 system quota failures.
22758 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22759 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22760 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22761 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22762 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22763 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22764 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22765 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22766 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22767 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22770 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22771 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22772 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22773 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22774 delivery directory.
22777 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22778 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22779 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22780 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22781 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22784 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22785 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22787 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22788 See &%quota%& above.
22791 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22792 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22793 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22794 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22795 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22796 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22797 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22799 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22800 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22801 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22802 the file length to the filename. For example:
22804 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22805 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22807 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22808 number of lines in the message.
22810 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22811 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22812 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22814 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22817 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22818 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22819 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22821 quota_warn_message = "\
22822 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22823 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22824 This message is automatically created \
22825 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22826 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22827 a warning threshold that is\n\
22828 set by the system administrator.\n"
22832 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22833 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22834 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22835 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22836 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22837 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22838 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22839 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22840 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22844 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22846 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22847 percent sign is ignored.
22849 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22850 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22851 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22852 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22853 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22854 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22856 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22858 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22859 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22862 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22863 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22867 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22868 .cindex "envelope from"
22869 .cindex "envelope sender"
22870 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22871 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22872 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22873 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22874 for details of batch SMTP.
22877 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22878 .cindex "carriage return"
22880 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22881 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22882 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22883 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22885 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22886 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22887 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22888 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22889 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22890 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22893 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22894 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22895 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22896 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22897 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22898 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22901 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22902 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22903 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22904 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22905 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22907 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22908 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22909 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22910 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22912 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22913 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22914 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22915 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22916 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22919 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22920 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22923 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22924 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22925 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22926 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22927 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22928 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22929 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22931 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22932 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22933 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22934 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22937 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22938 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22939 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22942 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22943 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22944 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22945 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22946 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22947 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22948 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22949 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22950 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22952 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22953 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22954 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22955 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22960 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22961 .cindex "appending to a file"
22962 .cindex "file" "appending"
22963 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22966 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22970 .cindex "directory creation"
22971 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22972 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22973 &%directory_mode%& option.
22976 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22977 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22981 .cindex "file" "locking"
22982 .cindex "locking files"
22983 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22984 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22985 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22988 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22989 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22990 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22992 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
22994 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22995 Unlink the hitching post name.
22997 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22998 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22999 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23000 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23002 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23003 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23004 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23005 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23006 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23007 it before trying again.
23011 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23012 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23013 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23016 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23017 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23018 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23019 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23020 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23021 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23022 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23023 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23024 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23028 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23029 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23030 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23031 delivery is deferred.
23034 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23035 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23036 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23040 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23041 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23042 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23045 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23046 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23047 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23050 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23051 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23052 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23053 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23054 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23055 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23056 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23057 that prevents link following.
23060 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23061 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23062 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23063 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23064 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23067 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23070 .cindex "file" "locking"
23071 .cindex "locking files"
23072 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23073 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23074 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23075 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23076 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23078 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23080 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23081 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23082 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23084 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23085 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23086 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23088 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23089 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23090 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23091 delivery is deferred.
23093 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23094 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23095 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23096 immediately. It retries up to
23098 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23100 times (rounded up).
23103 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23104 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23107 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23108 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23109 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23110 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23111 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23112 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23113 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23114 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23115 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23116 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23118 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23119 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23120 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23121 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23122 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23123 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23124 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23126 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23127 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23128 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23129 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23132 .cindex "maildir format"
23133 .cindex "mailstore format"
23134 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23135 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23136 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23137 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23138 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23140 .cindex "directory creation"
23141 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23142 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23143 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23144 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23145 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23146 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23151 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23152 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23153 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23154 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23155 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23156 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23157 &_new_& subdirectory.
23159 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23160 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23161 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23162 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23163 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23164 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23165 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23167 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23168 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23169 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23170 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23171 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23172 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23173 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23174 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23176 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23177 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23178 folders. Consider this example:
23180 maildir_format = true
23181 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23182 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23183 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23184 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23186 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23187 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23188 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23189 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23190 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23191 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23193 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23194 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23195 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23196 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23197 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23199 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23200 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23201 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23203 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23204 .cindex "maildir++"
23205 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23206 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23207 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23208 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23209 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23210 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23211 amount of space used.
23213 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23214 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23215 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23216 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23217 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23218 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23223 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23224 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23225 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23226 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23227 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23228 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23231 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
23232 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23233 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23234 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23235 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23236 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23237 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23238 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23239 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23240 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23241 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23242 backwards compatibility).
23244 For one common implementation, you might set:
23246 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23248 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23250 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23251 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23252 &[stat()]& each message file.
23255 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23256 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23257 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23258 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23259 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23260 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23261 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23262 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23263 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23265 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23266 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23267 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23268 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23269 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23270 need to know the quota.
23272 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23273 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23275 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23276 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23277 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23281 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23282 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23283 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23284 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23285 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23286 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23287 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23288 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23290 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23291 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23292 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23293 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23294 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23295 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23297 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23298 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23299 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23300 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23301 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23302 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23304 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23305 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23306 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23307 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23310 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23311 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23312 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23313 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23314 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23316 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23318 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23319 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23320 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23321 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23322 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23329 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23330 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23332 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23333 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23334 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23335 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23336 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23337 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23338 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23339 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23341 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23342 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23343 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23344 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23345 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23348 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23349 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23350 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23351 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23352 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23354 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23355 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23356 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23357 transport is run as a consequence of a
23359 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23360 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23361 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23362 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23363 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23364 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23366 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23367 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23368 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23369 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23371 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23372 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23373 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23374 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23375 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23376 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23377 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23379 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23380 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23381 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23382 the transport defers.
23383 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23384 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23386 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23387 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23388 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23389 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23391 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23392 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23393 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23394 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23395 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23396 problems. They are just discarded.
23400 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23401 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23403 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23404 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23405 message when the message is specified by the transport.
23408 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23409 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23410 when the message is specified by the transport.
23413 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
23414 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23415 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23416 string comes first.
23419 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23420 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23421 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23424 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23425 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23426 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23429 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23430 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23431 specified by the transport.
23434 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23435 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23436 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23437 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23440 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23441 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23442 the message is specified by the transport.
23445 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23446 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23450 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23451 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23452 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23453 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23454 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23458 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23459 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23460 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23461 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23463 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23464 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23465 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23466 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23467 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23468 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23469 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23472 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23473 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23474 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23475 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23476 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23478 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23479 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23480 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23481 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23482 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23483 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23486 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23487 See &%once%& above.
23490 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23491 See &%once%& above.
23492 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23495 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23496 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23497 specified by the transport.
23500 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23501 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23502 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23503 configuration option.
23506 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23507 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23508 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23509 automatic responses. For example:
23511 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23513 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23514 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23515 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23516 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23521 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23522 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23523 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23524 the text comes first.
23527 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23528 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23529 when the message is specified by the transport.
23530 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23531 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23536 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23537 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23539 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23540 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23541 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23542 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23543 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23544 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23546 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23547 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23548 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23549 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23550 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23551 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23555 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23556 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23557 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23560 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23561 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23564 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23565 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23566 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23567 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23568 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23571 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23572 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23573 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23574 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23575 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23576 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23579 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23580 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23581 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23582 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23583 in its response to the LHLO command.
23585 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23586 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23587 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23588 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23591 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23592 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23593 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23594 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23599 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23603 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23604 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23611 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23612 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23613 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23614 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23615 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23616 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23617 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23618 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23622 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23623 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23624 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23625 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23626 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23628 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23629 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23630 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23631 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23632 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23633 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23634 that are routed to the transport.
23636 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23637 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23638 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23639 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23640 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23641 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23642 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23646 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23647 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23648 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23650 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23651 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23652 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23653 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23654 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23655 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23656 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23659 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23660 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23661 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23662 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23663 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23664 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23665 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23670 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23671 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23672 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23673 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23674 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23675 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23676 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23677 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23678 &"local delivery failed"&.
23680 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23681 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23682 will be sent as normal.
23684 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23685 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23686 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23687 apply in this case.
23689 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23690 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23691 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23692 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23694 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23695 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23696 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23697 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23698 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23699 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23700 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23705 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23706 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23707 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23708 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23709 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23712 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23713 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23714 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23715 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23717 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23718 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23719 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23720 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23721 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23723 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23725 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23726 arguments. You have to write
23728 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23730 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23731 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23732 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23733 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23734 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23735 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23738 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23741 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23742 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23743 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23744 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23745 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23746 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23747 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23748 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23749 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23750 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23751 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23753 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
23754 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23755 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23756 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23757 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23758 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23759 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23760 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23762 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23763 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23764 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23765 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23766 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23767 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23768 control what is done with it.
23770 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23771 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23772 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23773 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23774 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23775 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23776 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23777 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23778 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23779 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23780 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23784 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23785 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23786 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23787 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23788 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23789 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23790 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23791 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23793 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23794 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23795 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23796 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23797 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23798 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23799 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23800 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23801 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23802 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23803 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23804 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23805 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23806 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23807 &`USER `& see below
23809 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23810 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23811 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23812 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23813 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23814 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23815 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23818 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23819 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23820 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23824 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23825 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23826 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23827 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23830 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23831 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23835 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23836 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23837 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23838 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23839 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23840 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23841 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23842 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23843 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23844 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23845 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23848 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23850 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23851 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23852 &%use_shell%& is set.
23855 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23856 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23859 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23860 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23861 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23864 .option check_string pipe string unset
23865 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23866 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23867 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23868 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23869 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23870 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23871 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23875 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23876 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23877 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23878 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23879 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23880 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23881 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23884 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23885 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23886 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23887 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23888 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23889 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23890 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23893 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23894 See &%check_string%& above.
23897 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23898 .cindex "exec failure"
23899 .cindex "failure of exec"
23900 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23901 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23902 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23903 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23904 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23907 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23908 .cindex "signal exit"
23909 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23910 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23911 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23912 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23915 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23916 .cindex "force command"
23917 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23918 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23919 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23920 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23921 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23922 command. For example:
23924 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23928 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23929 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23930 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23933 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23934 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23935 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23936 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23937 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23938 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23940 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23941 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23944 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23945 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23946 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23947 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23948 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23949 written to the main log.
23952 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23953 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23954 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23955 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23956 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23957 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23961 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23962 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23963 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23964 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23965 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23968 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23969 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23970 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23971 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23972 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23973 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23974 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23975 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23978 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23979 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23980 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23983 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23987 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23988 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23989 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23990 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23991 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23996 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23997 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24000 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24001 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24002 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24003 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24007 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24008 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24011 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24012 This option is expanded and
24013 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24014 variable of the subprocess.
24015 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24016 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24017 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24020 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24021 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24022 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24023 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24024 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24025 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24026 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24027 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24028 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24031 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24032 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24033 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24034 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24035 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24036 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24037 accept the message is used.
24040 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24041 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24042 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24043 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24044 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24045 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24048 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24049 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24050 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24051 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24052 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24053 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24054 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24058 .option return_output pipe boolean false
24059 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24060 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24061 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24062 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24063 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24064 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24065 of them may be set.
24069 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24070 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24071 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24072 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24073 and &%return_output%& is not set,
24074 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24075 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24076 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24077 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24078 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24079 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24080 and 73, respectively.
24083 .option timeout pipe time 1h
24084 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24085 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24086 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24087 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24088 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24089 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24091 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24092 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24093 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24094 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24095 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24096 delivery to be deferred.
24098 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24099 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24102 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24103 .cindex "envelope sender"
24104 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24105 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24106 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24107 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24108 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24110 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24111 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24112 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24113 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24114 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24115 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24119 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24120 .cindex "carriage return"
24122 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24123 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24124 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24125 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24127 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24128 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24129 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24130 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24131 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24134 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24135 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24136 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24137 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24138 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24139 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24140 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24141 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24142 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24147 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24148 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24149 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24150 .cindex "external local delivery"
24151 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24152 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24153 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24154 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24155 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24156 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24157 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24158 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24159 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24160 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24165 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24169 check_string = "From "
24170 escape_string = ">From "
24179 transport = procmail_pipe
24181 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24182 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24183 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24184 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24185 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24186 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24188 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24192 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24193 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24196 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24197 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24200 local_delivery_cyrus:
24202 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24203 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24215 local_part_suffix = .*
24216 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24218 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24219 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24221 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24222 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
24225 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24226 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24228 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24229 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24230 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24231 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24232 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24233 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24234 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24235 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24238 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24239 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24243 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24244 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24245 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24246 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24247 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24248 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24249 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24251 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24252 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24253 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24254 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24255 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24256 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24261 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24262 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24263 no further messages are sent over that connection.
24267 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24269 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24270 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24271 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24272 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24273 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24274 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24275 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24276 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24279 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24280 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
24281 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24282 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24283 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
24284 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24285 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24286 are the values that were set when the message was received.
24287 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24288 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24289 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24290 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24291 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24292 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24294 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24295 and will be removed in a future release.
24298 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24299 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24300 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24303 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24304 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24305 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24306 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24307 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24308 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24309 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24310 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24312 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24313 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24314 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24315 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24316 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24317 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24318 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24319 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24320 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24323 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24325 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24326 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24327 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24328 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24329 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24332 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24333 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24334 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24335 particular connection.
24337 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24338 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24339 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24340 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24342 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24343 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24344 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24346 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24348 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24349 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24351 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24352 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24356 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24357 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24358 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24359 authenticated as a client.
24362 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24363 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24364 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24365 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24368 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24369 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24370 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24371 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24372 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24373 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24374 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24377 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24378 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24379 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24380 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24381 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24382 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24383 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24387 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24388 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24389 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24390 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24391 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24392 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24393 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24394 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24395 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24396 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24397 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24398 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24399 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24400 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24403 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24404 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24405 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24406 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24409 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24410 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24411 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24412 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24413 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24414 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24415 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24416 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24417 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24418 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24421 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24422 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24423 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
24424 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24425 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24428 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24429 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24430 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24431 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24432 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24433 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24435 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24436 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24437 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24438 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24439 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24440 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24441 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24442 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24446 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24447 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24448 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24449 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24450 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24453 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24454 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24455 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24456 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24460 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24461 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24462 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24463 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24464 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24465 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24466 the dnssec request bit set.
24467 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24471 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24472 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24473 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24474 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24475 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24476 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24477 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24478 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24479 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24483 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24484 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24485 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24486 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24487 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24488 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24489 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24491 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24492 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24493 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24494 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24495 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24498 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24499 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24500 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24501 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24502 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24503 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24504 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24505 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24507 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24508 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24509 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24510 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24511 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24512 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24514 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24515 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24516 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24517 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24518 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24520 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24521 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24522 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24523 copy of the message is sent.
24525 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24526 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24527 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24528 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24532 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24533 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24534 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24537 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24538 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24539 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24540 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24541 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24542 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24544 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24545 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24546 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24547 implementations of TLS.
24549 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24550 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24551 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24552 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24553 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24554 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24555 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24560 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24561 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24562 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24563 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24564 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24565 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24566 interface address, you could use this:
24568 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24569 {$primary_hostname}}
24571 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24574 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24575 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24576 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24577 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24578 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24579 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24581 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24582 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24583 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24584 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24586 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24587 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24588 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24589 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24590 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24591 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24592 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24594 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24595 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24596 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24597 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24598 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24599 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24600 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24603 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24604 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24607 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24608 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24609 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24610 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24611 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24612 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24613 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24614 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24615 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24616 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24619 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24620 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24621 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24622 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24625 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24626 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24627 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24628 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24629 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24630 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24632 The retry hints database is used for the record,
24633 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24634 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24635 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24636 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24639 When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24640 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24642 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24643 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24644 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24645 You have been warned.
24649 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24650 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24651 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24652 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24654 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24655 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24656 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24657 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24658 to any host that matches this list.
24661 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24662 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24663 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24664 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24665 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24666 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24667 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24668 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24671 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24672 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24673 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24678 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24679 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24680 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24681 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24682 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24683 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24684 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24685 explanation of when this might be needed.
24688 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24689 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24690 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24691 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24692 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24693 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24694 message on the same session.
24697 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24698 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24699 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24700 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24701 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24702 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24707 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24708 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24709 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24710 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24711 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24714 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24715 .cindex "randomized host list"
24716 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24717 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24718 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24719 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24720 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24721 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24722 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24723 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24725 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24726 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24727 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24728 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24730 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24732 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24733 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24734 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24736 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24737 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24738 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24739 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24740 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24741 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24742 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24743 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24744 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24747 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24748 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24749 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24750 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24751 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24753 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24754 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24755 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24756 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24757 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24758 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24759 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24760 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24762 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24763 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24764 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24765 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24766 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24768 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24769 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24770 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24771 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24772 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24773 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24775 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24776 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24777 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24778 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24779 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24780 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24781 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24783 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24784 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24785 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24786 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24787 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24788 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24789 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24791 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
24792 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24793 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24794 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24795 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24796 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24797 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24798 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24799 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24801 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
24802 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24803 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24804 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24805 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24806 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24807 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24808 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24809 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24810 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24812 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24813 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24815 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24816 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24817 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24818 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24819 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24821 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24822 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24823 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24824 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24825 for multi-recipient messages.
24826 The option can usually be left as default.
24828 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24829 .cindex "bind IP address"
24830 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24832 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24833 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24834 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24835 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24836 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24837 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24838 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24839 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24842 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24843 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24844 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24845 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24846 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24847 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24850 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24852 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24853 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24854 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24855 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24858 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24859 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24860 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24861 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24862 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24863 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24864 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24865 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24866 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24867 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24871 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24872 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24873 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24874 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24875 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24877 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24878 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24879 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24880 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24881 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24885 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24886 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24887 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24888 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24889 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24890 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24891 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24892 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24894 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24895 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24896 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24898 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24899 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24900 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24901 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24902 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24903 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24904 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24905 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24907 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24908 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24910 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
24911 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
24912 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24915 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
24916 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
24920 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24921 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24922 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24923 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24925 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24926 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24927 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24928 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24929 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24931 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24932 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24933 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24934 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
24935 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
24936 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
24939 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24940 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24941 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24942 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24943 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24944 addresses is not affected.
24946 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24947 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24948 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24949 Exim to use only the host name.
24950 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24953 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24954 .cindex "serializing connections"
24955 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24956 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24957 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24958 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24959 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24960 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24961 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24963 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24964 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24965 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24966 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24967 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24968 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24970 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24971 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24972 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24973 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24974 are used for ETRN serialization.
24976 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24979 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24980 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24981 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24982 .cindex "size" "of message"
24983 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24984 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24985 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24986 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24987 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24988 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24989 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24990 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24992 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24993 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24996 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24997 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24998 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24999 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25002 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25003 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25004 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25006 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25007 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25008 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25009 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25010 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25013 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25014 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25015 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25016 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25020 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25021 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25022 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25023 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25024 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25027 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25028 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25029 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25030 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25031 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25032 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25035 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25038 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25039 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25041 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25042 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25043 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25044 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25045 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25046 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25047 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25048 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25051 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25052 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25053 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25055 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25056 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25057 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25058 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25059 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25060 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25061 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25062 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25063 ciphers is a preference order.
25067 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25068 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25069 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25070 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25071 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25072 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25073 certificate and private key for the session.
25075 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25077 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25083 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25084 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25085 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25086 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25087 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25088 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25089 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25090 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25091 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25092 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25096 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25097 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25098 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25099 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25100 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25101 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25102 Note that unless the host is in this list
25103 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25104 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25105 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25106 certificate verification succeeds.
25109 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25110 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25111 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25112 This option give a list of hosts for which,
25113 while verifying the server certificate,
25114 checks will be included on the host name
25115 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25116 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25117 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25119 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25122 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25123 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25124 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25126 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25127 The value of this option must be either the
25129 or the absolute path to
25130 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25131 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25133 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25134 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25135 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25138 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25139 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25141 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25143 either by file or directory
25144 are added to those given by the system default location.
25146 The values of &$host$& and
25147 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25148 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25150 For back-compatibility,
25151 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25152 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25153 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25156 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25157 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25158 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25159 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25160 certificate verification must succeed.
25161 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25162 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25163 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25165 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25166 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25167 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25168 If built with internationalization support,
25169 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25171 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25176 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25178 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25179 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25180 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25181 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25182 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25185 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25186 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25187 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25188 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25191 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25192 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25193 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25195 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25196 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25197 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25198 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25199 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25201 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25202 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25203 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25204 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25205 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25206 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25207 see below for an exception).
25209 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25210 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25211 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25212 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25213 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25215 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25216 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25217 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25218 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25219 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25220 reached their retry times.
25222 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25223 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25224 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25225 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25226 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25227 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25228 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25229 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25230 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25231 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25234 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25235 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25236 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25237 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25238 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25239 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25241 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25242 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25243 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25244 possible IP addresses have been tried.
25245 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
25246 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
25252 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25253 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25255 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25256 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25257 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25258 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25259 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25260 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25262 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25263 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25264 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25265 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25266 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25267 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25268 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25270 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25271 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25272 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25273 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25276 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25277 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25278 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25279 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25281 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25282 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25283 facility; you do not have to use it.
25285 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25286 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25287 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25288 address to which it applies.
25290 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25291 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25292 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25293 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25294 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25295 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25298 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25299 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25300 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25301 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25304 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25305 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25306 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25307 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25308 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25311 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25312 illustrated by these examples:
25315 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25316 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25317 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25318 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25320 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25321 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25326 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25327 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25328 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25329 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25330 message's processing.
25332 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25333 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25334 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25335 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25336 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25337 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25338 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25339 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25340 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25342 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25343 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25344 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25345 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25346 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25347 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25348 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25349 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25350 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25351 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25353 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25354 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25355 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25356 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25357 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25358 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25360 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25361 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25362 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25364 .cindex "envelope from"
25365 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25366 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25367 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25368 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25369 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25370 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25371 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25372 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25373 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25375 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25376 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25382 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25383 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25384 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25385 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25386 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25387 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
25388 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25389 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25390 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25391 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25393 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25395 might produce the output
25397 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25398 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25399 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25400 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25401 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25402 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25403 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25404 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25406 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25407 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25408 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25409 set for a particular transport.
25412 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25413 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25414 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25417 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25419 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25420 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25421 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25422 any colons must be doubled, of course).
25424 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25425 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25426 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25427 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25430 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25431 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25432 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25434 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25435 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25436 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25437 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25438 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25439 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25440 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25442 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25443 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25444 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25445 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25446 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25450 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25451 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25454 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25455 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25456 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25457 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25458 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25459 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25460 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25461 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25462 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25464 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25465 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25466 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25468 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25469 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25470 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25471 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25472 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25473 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25474 of pattern they are set as follows:
25477 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25478 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25479 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25482 *queen@*.fict.example
25484 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25486 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25490 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25491 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25494 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25495 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25496 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25497 rewriting rule of the form
25499 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25501 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25507 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25508 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25509 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25510 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25511 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25515 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25516 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25517 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25518 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25519 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25521 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25523 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25526 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25527 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25528 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25529 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25530 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25531 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25532 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25533 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25534 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25535 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25536 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25537 entry written to the panic log.
25541 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25542 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25545 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25548 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25550 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25553 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25554 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25558 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25560 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25561 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25562 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25563 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25564 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25565 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25567 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25568 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25569 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25570 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25571 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25572 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25573 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25574 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25575 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25576 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25578 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25579 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25580 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25582 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25583 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25586 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25587 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25588 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25589 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25590 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25591 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25592 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25593 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25594 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25596 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25597 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25598 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25599 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25600 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25601 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25602 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25603 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25606 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25607 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25608 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25609 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25612 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25613 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25614 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25616 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25617 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25618 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25619 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25621 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25622 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25623 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25625 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25626 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25627 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25628 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25630 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25634 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25637 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25638 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25639 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25640 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25641 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25642 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25643 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25644 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25646 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25647 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25651 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25652 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25654 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25655 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25656 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25658 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25659 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25660 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25661 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25662 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25663 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25664 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25665 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25667 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25668 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25670 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25672 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25673 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25675 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25676 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25677 messages that originate outside the local host:
25679 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25680 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25682 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25685 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25686 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25687 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25688 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25689 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25690 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25691 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25692 components. For example, the rule
25694 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25696 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25697 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25698 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25699 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25700 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25701 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25702 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25709 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25710 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25712 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25713 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25714 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25715 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25716 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25717 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25718 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25719 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25720 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25721 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25722 address, domain and error.
25724 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25725 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25726 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25727 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25728 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25729 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25730 log selector is set, the message
25731 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25732 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25733 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25734 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25736 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25737 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25738 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25739 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25740 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25741 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25742 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25743 domain are maintained independently.
25745 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25746 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25747 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25748 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25749 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25750 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25751 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25752 the local address is reached.
25754 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25755 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25756 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25757 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25758 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25760 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25761 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25762 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25763 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25764 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25765 messages that it should now be retaining.
25769 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25770 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25771 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25772 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25773 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25774 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25775 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25776 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25777 message's sender, respectively.
25780 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25781 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25782 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25783 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25784 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25785 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25788 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25790 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25793 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25795 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25796 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25799 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25800 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25801 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25802 expressions work in address lists.
25804 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25805 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25809 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25810 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25811 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25812 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25813 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25814 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25815 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25816 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25817 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25819 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25820 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25821 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25822 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25825 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25826 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25827 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25828 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25829 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25830 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25831 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25832 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25833 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25834 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25839 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25841 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25842 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25843 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25844 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25845 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25846 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25848 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25852 and the retry rules are
25854 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25855 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25857 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25858 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25859 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25860 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25861 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25862 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25864 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25865 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25866 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25867 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25869 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25870 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25871 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25873 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25875 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25876 textual form of the IP address.
25878 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25879 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25880 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25881 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25884 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25885 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25886 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25888 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25889 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25890 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25892 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25893 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25895 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25896 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25899 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25900 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25901 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25902 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25903 retry rule of this form:
25905 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25907 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25908 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25911 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25912 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25913 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25914 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25917 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25918 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25919 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25920 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25921 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25923 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25924 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25926 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25927 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25930 A connection was refused.
25932 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25933 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25935 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25936 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25938 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25939 A connection attempt timed out.
25941 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25942 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25943 obtained from an MX record.
25945 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25946 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25947 obtained from an MX record.
25950 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25952 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25953 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25954 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25955 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25958 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25961 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25962 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25963 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25964 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25965 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25966 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25970 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25971 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25972 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25973 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25974 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25978 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25979 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25980 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25982 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25983 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25984 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25985 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25986 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25987 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25988 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25990 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25991 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25994 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25995 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25996 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26001 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26002 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26003 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26004 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26005 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26008 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26010 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26012 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26014 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26015 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26018 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26020 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26021 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26022 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26023 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26024 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26026 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26027 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
26029 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26031 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26032 list is never matched.
26038 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26039 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26040 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26041 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26043 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26045 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26046 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26047 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26048 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26049 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26051 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26052 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26053 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26054 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26055 The available algorithms are:
26058 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26061 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26062 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26063 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26065 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26066 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26067 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26068 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26069 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26070 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26071 queue processing times.
26074 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26075 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26076 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26077 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26078 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26079 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26080 interval is found. The main configuration variable
26081 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26082 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26083 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26084 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26085 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26087 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26088 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26089 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26090 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26091 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26092 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26095 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26096 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26097 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26098 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26099 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26100 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26101 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26102 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26103 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26104 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26105 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26106 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26108 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26109 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26110 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26111 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26112 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26113 deliveries that have been deferred.
26116 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26117 Here are some example retry rules:
26119 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26120 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26121 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26122 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26123 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26124 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26126 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26127 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26128 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26129 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26130 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26131 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26132 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26135 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26136 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26137 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26138 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26139 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26141 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26142 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26143 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26144 were not obtained from an MX record.
26146 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26147 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26148 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26149 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26150 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26154 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26155 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26156 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26157 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26158 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26159 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26160 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26161 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26162 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26163 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26164 failing for the first time.
26166 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26167 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26168 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26169 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26171 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26172 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26173 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26178 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26179 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26180 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26181 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26182 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26183 default retry rule:
26185 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26187 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26188 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26189 failure for the recipient address that counts.
26191 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26192 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26193 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26194 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26195 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26197 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26198 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26199 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26201 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26202 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
26203 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26204 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26205 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26206 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26207 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26208 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26209 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26210 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26211 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26213 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26214 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26215 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26216 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26217 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26220 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26221 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26222 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26223 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26224 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26225 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26226 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26227 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26228 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26231 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26232 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26233 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26234 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26235 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26236 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26237 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26238 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26241 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26242 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26243 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26244 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26245 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26246 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26247 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26248 time out the address.
26250 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26251 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26252 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26253 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26254 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26255 considered immediately.
26256 .ecindex IIDretconf1
26257 .ecindex IIDregconf2
26264 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26265 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26267 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26268 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26269 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26270 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26271 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26272 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26273 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26274 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26275 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26278 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26279 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26282 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26283 the client's EHLO command.
26285 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26286 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26288 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26289 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26290 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26291 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26292 with the AUTH command.
26294 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26296 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26297 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26298 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26301 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26302 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26303 unauthenticated connection.
26306 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26307 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26308 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26309 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26311 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26312 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26313 &`Connected to server.example.`&
26314 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
26315 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26316 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26317 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26318 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26323 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26324 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26325 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26326 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26327 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26328 included by setting
26331 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26335 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26340 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26341 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26342 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26343 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26344 work via a socket interface.
26346 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26347 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26349 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26350 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26351 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26352 supporting setting a server keytab.
26353 The seventh can be configured to support
26354 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26355 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26356 The eighth authenticator
26357 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26358 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26359 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26361 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26362 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26363 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26364 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26365 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26366 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26367 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26369 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26370 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26371 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26372 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26373 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26374 both sets of options, is required. For example:
26378 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26379 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26381 client_secret = secret2
26383 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26384 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26386 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26387 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26388 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26391 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26392 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26393 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26394 authenticating data.
26396 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26397 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26398 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26399 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26400 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26401 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26402 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26403 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26404 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26405 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26408 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26409 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26410 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26411 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26415 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26416 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26417 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26419 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26420 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26421 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26422 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26423 encrypted by a setting such as:
26425 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26429 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26430 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26431 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26432 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26435 .option driver authenticators string unset
26436 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26437 authenticators is to be used.
26440 .option public_name authenticators string unset
26441 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26442 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26443 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26444 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26445 defaults to the driver's instance name.
26448 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26449 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26450 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26451 mechanism is not advertised.
26452 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26453 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26454 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26457 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26458 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26459 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26462 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26463 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26465 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26466 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26467 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26468 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26469 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26470 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26471 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26472 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26473 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26477 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26478 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26479 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26480 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26481 out the values of variables.
26482 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26483 output, and Exim carries on processing.
26486 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26487 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26488 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26489 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26490 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26491 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26492 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26493 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26494 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26495 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26496 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26497 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26500 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26501 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26502 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26503 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26504 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26505 remembered for later use.
26506 How it is used is described in the following section.
26512 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26513 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26514 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26515 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26516 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26520 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26521 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26523 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26525 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26526 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26527 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26528 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26529 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26530 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26531 given for the MAIL command.
26533 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26534 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26537 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26538 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26539 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26540 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26541 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26542 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26543 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26548 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26549 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26550 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26551 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26553 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26554 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26555 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26556 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26557 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26562 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26563 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26564 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26565 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26569 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26571 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26572 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26575 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26576 the mechanisms are advertised.
26578 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26579 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26580 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26581 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26582 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26583 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26584 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26586 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26588 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26590 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26591 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26592 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26595 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26597 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26598 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26599 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26601 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26602 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26603 command. This is the case if
26606 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26608 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26610 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26611 server authenticators.
26615 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26616 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26617 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26619 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26620 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26621 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26622 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26623 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26624 rejected with a 504 error.
26626 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26627 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26628 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26629 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26630 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26631 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26632 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26633 no successful authentication.
26635 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26636 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26637 &$authresults$& expansion item.
26642 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26643 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26644 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26645 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26646 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26647 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26648 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26652 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26654 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26655 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26656 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26657 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26658 command line to run this script on such data might be
26660 encode '\0user\0password'
26662 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26663 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26664 whose code value is zero.
26666 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26667 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26668 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26669 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26671 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26672 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26673 example, a command such as
26675 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26677 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26679 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26680 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26682 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26684 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26685 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26686 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26687 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26691 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26692 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26693 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26694 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26695 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26696 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26699 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26700 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26701 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26702 of the authenticator.
26705 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26706 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26707 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26708 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26709 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26710 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26711 delivery to be deferred.
26713 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26714 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26715 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26718 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26719 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26720 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26721 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26722 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26723 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26724 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26725 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26726 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26729 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26730 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26731 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26732 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26733 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26734 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26735 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26736 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26738 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26740 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26741 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26742 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26743 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26744 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26745 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26746 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26747 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26748 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26749 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26750 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26751 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26752 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26759 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26760 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26762 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26763 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26764 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26765 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26766 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26767 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26768 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26769 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26770 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26771 connections as you do for login accounts.
26773 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26774 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26775 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26777 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26778 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26779 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26781 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26782 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26783 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26786 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26787 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26788 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26789 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26790 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26791 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26792 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26794 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26795 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26796 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26797 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26798 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26799 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26800 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26802 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26803 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26804 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26805 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26807 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26808 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26809 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26811 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26812 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26813 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26814 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26815 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26816 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26817 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26818 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26819 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26820 string as the error text.
26822 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26823 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26824 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26828 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26829 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26830 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26831 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26832 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26833 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26834 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26835 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26837 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26838 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26839 configured as follows:
26843 public_name = PLAIN
26845 server_condition = \
26846 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26847 server_set_id = $auth2
26849 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26850 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26851 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26852 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26854 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26855 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26856 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26857 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26861 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26863 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26865 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26866 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26870 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26871 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26873 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26874 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26875 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26876 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26877 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26879 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26880 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26881 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26883 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26884 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26885 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26886 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26887 This is an incorrect example:
26889 server_condition = \
26890 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26892 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26893 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26894 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26895 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26896 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26897 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26898 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26900 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26901 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26903 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26904 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26905 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26906 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26907 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26910 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26911 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26912 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26913 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26914 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26915 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26916 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26920 public_name = LOGIN
26921 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26922 server_condition = \
26923 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26924 server_set_id = $auth1
26926 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26927 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26928 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26929 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26931 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26932 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26933 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26934 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26935 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26939 public_name = LOGIN
26940 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26941 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26944 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26945 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26946 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26947 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26949 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26950 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26951 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26952 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26953 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26954 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26955 uninterpreted string.
26958 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26959 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26960 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26961 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26962 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26968 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26969 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26970 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26972 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26973 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26974 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26975 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26978 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26979 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26980 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26981 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26982 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26983 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26984 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26985 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26986 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26987 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26988 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26989 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26991 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26992 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26994 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26995 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26996 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26997 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27000 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27001 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27005 public_name = PLAIN
27006 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27008 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27009 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27010 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27014 public_name = LOGIN
27015 client_send = : username : mysecret
27017 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27018 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27020 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27021 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27026 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27027 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27029 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27030 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27031 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27032 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27033 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
27034 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27035 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27036 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27037 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27038 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27039 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27040 available in plain text at either end.
27043 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27044 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27045 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27046 authenticator as a server:
27048 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27049 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27050 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27051 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27052 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27053 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27054 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27055 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27056 returned to the client.
27058 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27059 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27060 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27061 numeric variables for other things.
27063 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27064 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27065 user name, authentication fails.
27069 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27070 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27071 server_set_id = $auth1
27073 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27074 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27075 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27076 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27080 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27081 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27083 server_set_id = $auth1
27085 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27086 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27088 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27089 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27090 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27095 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27096 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27097 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27098 server_set_id = $auth1
27101 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27102 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27103 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27107 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27108 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27109 computing the response to the server's challenge.
27112 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27113 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27114 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27118 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27119 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27120 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27121 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27122 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27123 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27124 send the message to the current server.
27126 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27131 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27133 client_secret = secret
27135 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27136 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27140 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27141 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27143 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27144 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27145 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27146 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27148 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27149 at A L Digital Ltd.
27151 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27152 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27153 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27154 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27155 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27157 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27158 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27159 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27160 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27162 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27163 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27164 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27165 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27166 depending on the driver you are using.
27168 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27169 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27170 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27171 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27172 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27175 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27176 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27177 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27178 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27179 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27180 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27181 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27182 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27185 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27186 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27187 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27188 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27189 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27190 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27194 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27195 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27196 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27197 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27200 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27201 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27202 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27203 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27207 driver = cyrus_sasl
27208 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27209 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27210 server_set_id = $auth1
27213 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27214 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27217 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27218 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27221 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27222 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27223 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27224 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27227 driver = cyrus_sasl
27228 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27229 server_set_id = $auth1
27232 driver = cyrus_sasl
27233 public_name = PLAIN
27234 server_set_id = $auth2
27236 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27237 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27238 but it is present in many binary distributions.
27239 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27240 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27245 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27247 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27248 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27249 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27250 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27251 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27252 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27253 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27254 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27255 authenticator only. There is only one option:
27257 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
27259 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27260 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27261 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27262 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27266 public_name = PLAIN
27267 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27268 server_set_id = $auth1
27273 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27274 server_set_id = $auth1
27276 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27277 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27278 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27279 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27280 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27281 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27282 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27283 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27286 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27287 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27288 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27289 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27290 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27291 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27292 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27293 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27294 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27295 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27296 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27297 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27298 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27299 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27300 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
27301 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27302 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27303 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27304 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27305 without code changes in Exim.
27307 Exim's &(gsasl)& authenticator does not have client-side support at this
27308 time; only the server-side support is implemented. Patches welcome.
27311 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27312 Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27314 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27315 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27316 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27317 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27320 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27321 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27322 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27324 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
27325 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27326 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27328 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27329 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27330 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27332 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
27333 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27334 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27337 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27338 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27339 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27340 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27343 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27344 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27345 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27346 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27351 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27352 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27353 server_set_id = $auth1
27357 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27358 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27359 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27360 the password itself.
27362 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27363 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27364 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27365 if available, else the empty string.
27366 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27367 else the empty string.
27369 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27371 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27372 option to be simply "true".
27375 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27376 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27377 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27380 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
27381 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27382 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27383 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27386 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27387 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27388 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27389 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27392 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27393 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27394 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27397 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27398 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27399 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27400 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27402 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27403 meanings for these variables:
27406 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27407 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27409 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27410 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27412 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
27413 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27416 On a per-mechanism basis:
27419 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27420 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27421 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27423 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27424 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27425 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27427 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27428 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27429 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27430 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27433 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27434 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27435 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27438 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27439 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27441 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27443 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27444 server_realm = imap.example.org
27445 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27446 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27447 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27448 server_condition = yes
27452 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27453 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27455 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27456 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27457 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27458 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27459 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27460 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27461 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27464 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27465 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27466 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27467 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27469 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27470 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27471 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27472 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27474 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27475 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27476 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27480 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27481 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27482 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27483 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27485 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27486 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27487 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27488 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27490 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27492 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27493 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27495 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27496 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27497 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27502 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27503 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27505 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27506 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27507 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27508 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27509 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27510 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27511 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27512 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27513 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27514 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27515 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27516 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27517 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27521 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27522 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27524 The server sends back a challenge.
27526 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27527 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27530 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27534 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27535 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27536 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27538 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27539 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27540 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27541 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27542 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27543 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27544 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27545 for other things. For example:
27550 server_password = \
27551 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27553 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27554 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27560 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27561 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27562 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27566 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27567 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27570 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27571 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27574 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27575 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27576 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27582 client_username = msn/msn_username
27583 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27584 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27586 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27587 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27593 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27594 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27596 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27597 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27598 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27599 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27600 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27601 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27602 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27603 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27604 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27605 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27606 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27607 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27608 by the server configuration.
27610 The client presents an identity in-clear.
27611 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27612 and for clients to only attempt,
27613 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27615 One possible use, compatible with the
27616 K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27617 is for using X509 client certificates.
27619 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27620 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27621 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27622 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27623 client certificates only.
27625 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27626 client-certificate authentication is being done.
27628 The client must present a certificate,
27629 for which it must have been requested via the
27630 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27631 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27632 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27633 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27635 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27636 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27637 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27639 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27640 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27641 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27642 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27643 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27644 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27645 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27647 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27649 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27650 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27651 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27652 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27653 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27654 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27656 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27657 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27658 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27659 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27660 an identity for authentication and
27661 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27663 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27664 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27665 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27666 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27668 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27669 Once an identity has been received,
27670 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27671 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27672 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27673 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27674 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27675 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27676 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27677 string as the error text.
27681 ext_ccert_san_mail:
27683 public_name = EXTERNAL
27685 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27686 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27687 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27688 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27689 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27690 server_set_id = $auth1
27692 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27693 of your configured trust-anchors
27694 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27695 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27697 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27698 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27699 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27701 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27704 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27705 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27706 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27708 .option client_send external string&!! unset
27709 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27710 identity being asserted.
27716 public_name = EXTERNAL
27718 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27719 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27723 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
27724 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
27730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27731 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27733 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27734 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27735 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27736 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27737 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27738 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27739 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27740 authentication based on client certificates.
27742 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27743 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27744 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27745 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27746 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27747 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27749 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27750 for which it must have been requested via the
27751 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27752 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27754 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27755 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27756 and can authenticate the connection.
27757 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27759 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27762 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27763 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27765 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27766 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27767 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27768 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27769 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27770 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27772 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27773 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27774 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27776 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27783 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27784 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27785 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27788 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27789 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27790 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27792 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27794 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27795 of your configured trust-anchors
27796 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27797 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27799 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27800 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27801 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27803 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27805 . An alternative might use
27807 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27809 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27810 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27811 . This would help for per-device use.
27813 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27814 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27816 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27817 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27820 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27821 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27822 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27826 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27827 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27829 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27830 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27831 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27832 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27833 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27836 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27837 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27838 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27839 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27840 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27841 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27842 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27843 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27844 certificates are used.
27846 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27847 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27848 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27849 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27850 between them is encrypted.
27852 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27853 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27854 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27855 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27858 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27859 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27860 in order to get TLS to work.
27864 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27866 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27867 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27868 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27869 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27870 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27871 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27872 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27873 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27874 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27875 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27876 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27878 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27879 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27880 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27882 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27883 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27884 reassigned for other use.
27885 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27887 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27888 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27889 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27891 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27892 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27893 the most common use is expected to be:
27895 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27897 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27898 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27899 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27900 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27901 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27904 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27905 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27912 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27913 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27914 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27915 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27916 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27920 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27924 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27925 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27927 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27930 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27931 cannot be the path of a directory
27932 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27933 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27935 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27937 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27938 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27939 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27940 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27941 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27943 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27944 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27945 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27946 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27947 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27948 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27949 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27952 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27953 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27955 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27956 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27957 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27958 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27960 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27961 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27963 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27964 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27965 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27966 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27970 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27971 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27972 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27973 but not the chosen filename.
27974 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27975 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27977 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27978 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27979 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27980 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27982 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27983 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27984 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27985 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27986 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27987 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27988 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27990 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27991 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27992 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27993 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27994 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27996 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27997 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27998 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27999 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28000 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28001 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28003 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28004 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28005 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28007 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28008 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28009 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28010 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28013 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28016 # chown exim:exim new-params
28017 # chmod 0600 new-params
28018 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28019 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28020 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28021 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28022 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28023 # chmod 0400 new-params
28024 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28026 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28027 stalling is removed.
28029 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28030 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28031 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28032 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28033 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28034 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28035 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28036 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28037 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28038 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28039 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28041 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28042 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28043 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
28044 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28046 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28047 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28048 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28049 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28050 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28053 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28054 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28055 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28056 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28057 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28058 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28059 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28060 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28061 directly to this function call.
28062 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28063 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28064 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28065 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28068 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28070 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28071 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28072 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28075 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28076 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28077 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28081 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28084 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28085 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28088 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28089 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28091 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28092 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28095 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28096 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28097 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28098 not be moved to the end of the list.
28101 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28104 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28105 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28108 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28109 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28110 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28111 choice of clients used:
28113 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28114 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28119 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28121 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28124 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28125 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28126 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28127 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28129 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28131 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28135 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28137 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28138 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28139 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28140 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28141 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28142 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28143 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28144 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28145 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28146 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28148 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28149 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28151 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28152 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28153 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28154 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28155 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28156 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28158 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28159 "Priority strings". This is online as
28160 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28161 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28162 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28163 then the example code
28164 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28165 on that site can be used to test a given string.
28169 # Disable older versions of protocols
28170 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28173 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28174 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28175 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28177 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28178 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28179 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28180 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28184 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28190 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28191 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28192 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28193 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28194 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28195 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28196 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28198 If STARTTLS is to be used you
28199 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28201 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28202 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28203 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28206 554 Security failure
28208 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28209 rejected with a 554 error code.
28211 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28212 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28214 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28215 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28216 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28217 from someone able to intercept the communication.
28219 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28221 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28223 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28224 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28226 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28227 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28228 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28229 that goes with it. These files need to be
28230 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28231 always be given as full path names.
28232 The key must not be password-protected.
28233 They can be the same file if both the
28234 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28235 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28236 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28237 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28238 the server's certificate.
28240 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28241 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28242 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28243 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28244 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28245 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28247 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28248 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28249 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28251 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28252 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28253 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28256 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28257 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28258 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28260 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28262 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28263 with the parameters contained in the file.
28264 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28269 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28270 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28271 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28272 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28278 for a way of generating file data.
28280 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28281 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28282 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28283 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28284 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28286 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28287 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28288 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28289 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28290 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28291 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28292 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28293 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28294 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28296 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28297 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28298 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28299 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28300 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28301 documentation for more details.
28303 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28304 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28307 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28308 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28309 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28310 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28311 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28312 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28313 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28314 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28315 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28316 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28317 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28318 an explicit file or,
28319 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28320 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28322 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28325 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28326 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28327 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28329 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28331 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28333 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28334 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28336 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28337 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28338 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28339 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28340 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28341 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28342 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28343 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28344 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28345 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28347 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28348 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28349 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28350 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28352 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28353 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28354 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28355 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28356 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28357 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28360 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28361 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28362 .cindex "revocation list"
28363 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28364 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28365 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28366 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28367 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28368 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28369 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28371 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28372 file from every certificate authority they know of.
28374 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28375 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28376 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28377 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28378 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28379 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28381 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28382 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28383 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28384 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28386 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28387 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28388 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28389 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28390 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28391 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28392 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28393 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28395 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28396 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28397 support for OCSP stapling is included.
28399 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28400 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28401 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28402 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28403 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28405 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28406 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28407 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28408 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28409 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28412 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28413 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28416 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28417 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28418 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28419 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28420 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28421 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28423 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28424 not any of the chain from CA to it.
28426 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28429 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28430 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28431 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28433 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28434 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28435 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28441 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28442 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28443 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28444 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28445 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28446 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28447 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28448 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28449 within the &(smtp)& transport.
28451 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28452 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28453 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28454 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28455 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28457 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28458 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28459 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28460 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28461 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28464 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28465 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28466 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28467 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28468 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28469 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28470 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28471 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28472 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28473 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28476 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28477 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28478 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28479 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28482 Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28483 for client use (they are usable for server use).
28484 As TLS has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28485 in failed connections.
28488 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28489 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28491 the system default set (depending on library version),
28493 or (depending on library version) a directory.
28494 The client verifies the server's certificate
28495 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28496 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28497 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28498 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28500 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28501 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28502 or need not succeed respectively.
28504 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28505 checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28506 is valid for the certificate.
28507 The option defaults to always checking.
28509 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28510 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28511 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28513 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28514 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28515 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28518 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28519 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28520 for OCSP to be relevant.
28523 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28524 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28525 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28526 alternative hosts, if any.
28529 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28530 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28531 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28535 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28536 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28537 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28538 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28539 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28541 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28542 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28543 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28544 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28545 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28546 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28547 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28548 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28549 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28550 outgoing connection.
28554 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28555 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28556 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28557 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28558 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28559 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28560 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28561 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28562 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28563 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28566 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28567 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28570 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28571 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28572 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28573 be of limited use in that environment.
28575 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28576 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28577 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28578 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28579 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28581 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28582 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28583 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28584 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28585 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28587 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28588 received from a client.
28589 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28591 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28592 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28593 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28596 &%tls_certificate%&
28602 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
28607 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28608 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28609 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28610 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28611 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
28612 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28613 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28615 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28618 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28619 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28620 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28621 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28623 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
28624 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28625 built, then you have SNI support).
28629 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28631 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28632 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28633 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28634 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28635 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28636 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28637 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28638 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28639 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28640 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28642 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28643 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28644 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28645 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28646 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28647 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28648 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28650 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28651 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28652 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28653 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28654 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28655 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28656 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28657 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28658 and delay other deliveries to that host.
28660 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28661 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28662 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28663 information is recorded.
28665 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28666 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28667 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28672 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28673 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28674 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28675 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28676 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28677 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28679 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28680 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28681 document is currently at
28683 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28685 and their FAQ is at
28687 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28690 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28691 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28693 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28694 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28695 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28696 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28699 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28700 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28701 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28702 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28703 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28704 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28705 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28706 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28707 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28708 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28709 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28710 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28711 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28713 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28714 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28715 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28716 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28720 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28721 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28722 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28723 with OpenSSL, like this:
28724 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28725 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28727 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28730 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28731 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28732 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28733 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28734 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28735 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28736 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28738 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28739 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28740 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28741 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28742 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28743 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28745 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28746 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28747 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28748 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28749 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28750 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28751 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28752 be a sensible resolution).
28754 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28755 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28756 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28758 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28759 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28760 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28761 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28762 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28763 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28765 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28766 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28767 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28768 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28769 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28770 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28774 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28776 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28777 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28778 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28779 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28780 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28781 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28783 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28784 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28785 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28787 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28788 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28790 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28791 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28792 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28794 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28795 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28796 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28798 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28799 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28801 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28802 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28803 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28804 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28806 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28807 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28808 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28809 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28810 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28811 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28813 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28814 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
28815 does require careful arrangement.
28816 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28817 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28818 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28819 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28820 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28822 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28823 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28825 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28826 "MTA-STS", described below.
28828 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28829 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28830 connections to you.
28831 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28832 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28833 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28834 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28835 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28836 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28838 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28839 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
28840 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
28841 random serial numbers.
28842 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
28843 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
28844 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
28845 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
28847 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28849 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28850 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28853 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28854 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28859 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28861 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28863 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
28864 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
28865 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
28866 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
28868 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
28869 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
28871 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28872 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28873 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28876 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28877 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28881 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28882 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28883 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28884 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28885 control the OCSP request.
28887 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28888 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28891 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28892 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28893 The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28895 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28897 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28898 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28899 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28900 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28902 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28903 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28904 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28905 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28906 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28907 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28908 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28910 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28914 tls_try_verify_hosts
28915 tls_verify_certificates
28917 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28920 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28921 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28923 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28925 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28927 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28928 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28929 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28930 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28932 .cindex DANE reporting
28933 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28934 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28935 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28936 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28937 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28938 Section 4.3 of that document.
28940 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28942 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
28943 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
28944 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
28945 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
28946 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
28947 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
28948 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
28949 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
28952 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
28953 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
28954 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
28956 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
28957 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
28958 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
28959 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
28960 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
28961 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
28962 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
28966 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28967 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28969 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28970 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28971 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28972 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28973 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28974 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
28975 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28976 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28977 one very small ACL:
28981 accept hosts = one.host.only
28983 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28984 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28986 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28987 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28988 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28989 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28990 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28991 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28992 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28993 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28996 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28997 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28998 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29001 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29002 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29003 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29004 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29005 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29006 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29007 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29008 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29009 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29010 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29011 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29012 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29013 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29014 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29015 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29016 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29017 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29018 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29019 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29020 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29023 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29024 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29025 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29026 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29027 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29028 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29029 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29030 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29031 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29032 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29033 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29034 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29035 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29036 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29037 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29038 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29039 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29040 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29041 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29042 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29045 For example, if you set
29047 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29049 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29050 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29051 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29052 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29053 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29054 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29055 testing as possible at RCPT time.
29058 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29059 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29060 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29061 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29062 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29063 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29064 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29065 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29066 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29067 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29068 in any of these ACLs.
29070 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29071 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29072 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29073 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29074 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29075 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29076 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29077 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29079 control = suppress_local_fixups
29081 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29082 run, it is too late.
29084 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29085 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29087 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29088 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29089 temporary error for these kinds of message.
29092 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29093 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29094 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29095 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29096 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29097 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29098 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29099 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29100 &%smtp_banner%& option.
29103 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29104 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29105 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29106 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29107 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29108 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29109 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29110 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29111 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29113 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29114 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29115 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29117 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29118 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29119 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29120 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29124 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29125 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29126 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29127 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29128 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29129 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29130 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29131 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29132 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29133 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29135 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29136 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29137 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29138 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29139 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29140 associated with the DATA command.
29142 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29143 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29144 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29145 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29146 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29147 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29148 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29149 the data specified is received.
29151 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29152 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29153 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29154 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29155 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29158 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29159 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29160 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29161 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29163 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29164 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29165 enabled (which is the default).
29167 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29168 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29169 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29171 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29173 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29176 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29177 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29178 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29180 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29183 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29184 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29185 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29186 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29187 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29188 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29189 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29192 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29193 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29194 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29195 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29196 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29197 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29198 for some or all recipients.
29200 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29201 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29202 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29203 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29204 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29206 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29207 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29208 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29210 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29211 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29213 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29214 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29215 the feature was not requested by the client.
29217 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29218 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29219 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29220 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29221 does not in fact control any access.
29222 For this reason, it may only accept
29223 or warn as its final result.
29225 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29226 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29227 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29228 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29230 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29231 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29233 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29234 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29237 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29238 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29239 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29240 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29241 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29244 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29245 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29246 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29247 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29248 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29249 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29250 situation even worse.
29252 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29253 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29254 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29257 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29258 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29259 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29260 connection. The possible values are:
29262 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29263 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29264 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29265 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29266 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29267 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29268 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29269 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29270 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29271 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29273 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29274 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29275 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29276 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29277 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29281 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29282 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29283 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29284 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29286 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29287 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29289 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29290 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29291 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29292 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29293 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29295 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29296 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29297 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29300 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29301 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29302 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29303 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29304 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29305 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29307 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29308 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29309 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29311 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29312 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29313 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29314 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29316 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29317 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29318 matches the string.
29320 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29321 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29322 want to have something like
29324 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29326 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29327 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29333 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29334 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29335 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29336 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29337 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29338 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29339 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29340 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29341 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29343 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29344 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29345 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29348 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29349 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29350 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29351 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29353 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29354 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29355 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29356 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29357 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29358 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29359 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29361 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29362 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29365 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29366 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29367 recipients; it may create new recipients.
29371 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29372 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29373 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29374 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29375 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29376 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29378 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29379 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29380 used to accept or reject anything.
29382 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29383 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29384 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29385 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29387 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29388 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29389 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29390 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29391 configuration file.
29396 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29397 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29399 .vindex &$local_part$&
29400 .vindex &$sender_address$&
29401 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29402 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29403 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29404 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29405 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29406 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29407 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29408 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29410 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29411 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29412 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29415 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
29416 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29417 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29418 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29419 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29422 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29423 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29424 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29425 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29426 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29427 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29428 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29429 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29435 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29436 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29437 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29438 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29439 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29440 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29441 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29442 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29443 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29444 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29445 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29446 unencrypted connections.
29449 accept encrypted = *
29450 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29452 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29454 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29455 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29456 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29457 option to do this.)
29461 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29462 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29463 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29464 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29465 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29466 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29467 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29469 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29470 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29471 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29474 deny dnslists = list1.example
29475 dnslists = list2.example
29477 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29478 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29479 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29480 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29481 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29484 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29485 The ACL verbs are as follows:
29488 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29489 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29490 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29491 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29492 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29493 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29494 check a RCPT command:
29496 accept domains = +local_domains
29500 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29501 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29502 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29503 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29506 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29507 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29508 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29511 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29512 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29513 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29514 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29515 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29516 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29518 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29519 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29521 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29522 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29523 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29525 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29526 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29527 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29532 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29533 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29534 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29535 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29536 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29537 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29538 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29542 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29543 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29544 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29547 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29549 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29553 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29554 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29555 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29556 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29557 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29558 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29559 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29560 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29561 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29563 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29564 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29565 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29569 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29570 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29571 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29573 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29574 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29576 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29577 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29580 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29581 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29582 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29583 example, when checking a RCPT command,
29585 require message = Sender did not verify
29588 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29589 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29590 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29591 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29594 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29595 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29596 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29597 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29598 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29599 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29600 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29602 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29603 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29604 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29605 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29606 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29608 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29609 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29610 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29611 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29612 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29613 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29617 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29618 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29619 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29620 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29622 warn !verify = sender
29623 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29627 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29629 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29630 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29631 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29632 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29633 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29637 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29638 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29639 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29640 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29641 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29642 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29643 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29644 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29645 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29646 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29648 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29649 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29650 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29651 on the same SMTP connection.
29653 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29654 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29655 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29658 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29659 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29660 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29662 accept hosts = whatever
29663 set acl_m4 = some value
29664 accept authenticated = *
29665 set acl_c_auth = yes
29667 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29668 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29669 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29671 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29672 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29673 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29674 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29675 error is generated.
29677 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29678 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29681 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29682 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29683 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29684 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29686 deny domains = *.dom.example
29687 !verify = recipient
29689 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29690 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29691 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29692 two statements are equivalent:
29694 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29695 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29697 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29698 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29700 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29701 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29702 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29704 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29705 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29706 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29707 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29709 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29710 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29711 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29712 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29713 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29714 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29715 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29717 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29718 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29719 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29720 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29721 message is handled.
29723 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29724 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29725 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29726 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29728 require message = Can't verify sender
29730 message = Can't verify recipient
29732 message = This message cannot be used
29734 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29735 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29736 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29737 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29738 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29739 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29741 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29742 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29743 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29744 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29747 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29748 message = Invalid sender from client host
29750 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29751 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29755 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29756 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29757 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29760 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29761 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29762 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29763 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29765 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29766 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29767 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29768 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29769 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29770 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29771 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29772 write rather ugly lines like this:
29774 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29776 Instead, all you need is
29778 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29781 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29782 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29783 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29784 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29785 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29786 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29787 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29788 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29790 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29791 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29792 in several different ways. For example:
29794 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29795 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29796 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29800 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29802 accept ...some conditions
29803 control = queue_only
29805 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29806 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29809 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29811 accept ...some conditions...
29812 control = queue_only
29813 ...some more conditions...
29815 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29816 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29817 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29821 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29822 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29825 warn ...some conditions...
29829 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29830 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29834 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29835 &%require%& verb. For example:
29837 require control = no_multiline_responses
29841 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29842 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29844 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29845 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29846 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29847 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29848 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29849 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29851 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29854 deny ...some conditions...
29857 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29858 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29861 ...some conditions...
29863 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29864 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29866 warn ...some conditions...
29872 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29873 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29874 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29875 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29876 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29877 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29878 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29882 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29883 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29884 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29885 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29886 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29887 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29888 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29891 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29892 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29893 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29894 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29896 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29897 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29899 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29902 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29903 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29905 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29906 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29907 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29910 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29911 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29912 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29913 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29914 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29915 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29918 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29919 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29920 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29923 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29924 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29925 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29926 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29927 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29928 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29930 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29931 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29932 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29933 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29934 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29935 logging rejections.
29938 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29939 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29940 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29941 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29942 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29943 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29944 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29945 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29947 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29948 &` log_reject_target =`&
29950 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29951 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29955 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29956 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29957 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29958 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29959 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29960 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29961 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29964 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29965 &` control = freeze`&
29966 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29968 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29969 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29970 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29973 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29974 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29978 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29979 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29980 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29981 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29982 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29983 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29984 &%accept%& for details.)
29986 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29987 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29988 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29989 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29990 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29992 require message = Host not recognized
29995 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29998 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29999 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30000 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30001 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30002 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30003 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30004 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30005 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30006 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30009 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30010 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30011 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30013 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30014 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30016 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30017 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30018 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
30021 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30022 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30024 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30025 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30026 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30029 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30030 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30031 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30033 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30034 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30035 However, the original message is available in the variable
30036 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30037 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30038 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30039 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30041 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30042 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30043 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30044 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30045 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30046 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30050 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30051 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30052 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30053 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30055 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30057 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30058 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30059 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30060 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30063 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30064 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30065 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30066 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30069 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30070 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30071 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30072 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30075 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30076 .cindex "UDP communications"
30077 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30078 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30079 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30080 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30081 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30082 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30083 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30086 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30087 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30094 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30095 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30096 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30099 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30100 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30101 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30102 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30103 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30104 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30105 not work without it. For example:
30107 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30108 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30110 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30111 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30112 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30113 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30114 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30117 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30118 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30119 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30120 .cindex "case of local parts"
30121 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30122 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30123 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30124 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30125 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30126 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30129 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30130 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30131 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30132 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30133 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30135 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30136 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30139 warn control = caseful_local_part
30140 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30142 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30144 control = caselower_local_part
30146 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30147 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30150 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30151 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30152 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30153 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30155 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30156 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30157 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30158 is used for all recipients of the message,
30159 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30160 and data is copied from one to the other.
30162 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30163 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30164 If a recipient-verify callout
30166 connection is subsequently
30167 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30168 any subsequent recipients and the data,
30169 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30171 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30172 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30173 Note also that headers cannot be
30174 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30175 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30176 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30177 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30178 this will affect the timestamp.
30180 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30181 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30182 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30183 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30186 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30187 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30188 before the entire message has been received from the source.
30189 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30193 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30194 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30195 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30196 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30197 before the acceptance "<=" line.
30199 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30201 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30202 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30203 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30204 and does not queue the message.
30205 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30207 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30209 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30212 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30213 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30214 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30215 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30216 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30217 by default called &'debuglog'&.
30218 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30219 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30220 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30222 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30223 with the &'kill'& option.
30224 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30228 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30229 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30230 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30231 control = debug/kill
30235 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30236 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30237 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30238 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30239 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30242 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30243 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30244 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30245 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30246 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30247 strings or to numeric value.
30248 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30249 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30250 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30252 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30253 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30254 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30255 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30256 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30259 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30260 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30261 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30262 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30263 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30264 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30265 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30266 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30268 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30269 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30270 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30271 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30272 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30273 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30277 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30278 .cindex "fake defer"
30279 .cindex "defer, fake"
30280 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30281 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30282 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30283 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30284 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30286 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30287 .cindex "fake rejection"
30288 .cindex "rejection, fake"
30289 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30290 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30291 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30292 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30293 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30294 the same SMTP connection.
30296 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30297 message is supplied, the following is used:
30299 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30300 550-kept for evaluation.
30301 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30302 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30304 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30306 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30307 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30308 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30309 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30310 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30311 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30314 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30315 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30316 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30317 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30319 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30320 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30321 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30322 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30323 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30324 disables such output flushing.
30326 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30327 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30328 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30329 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30330 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30331 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30333 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30334 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30335 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30336 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30337 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30338 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30339 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30340 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30341 to be useful in production.
30343 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30344 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30345 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30346 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30347 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30349 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30350 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30351 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30352 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30353 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30354 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30357 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30358 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30359 verification failed"&) is sent.
30361 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30365 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30366 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30368 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30369 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30370 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30371 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30372 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30373 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30374 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30376 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30377 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30378 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30379 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30380 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30381 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30382 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30383 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30384 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30385 same SMTP connection.
30387 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30388 .cindex "message" "submission"
30389 .cindex "submission mode"
30390 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30391 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30392 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30393 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30394 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30395 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30396 late (the message has already been created).
30398 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30399 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30400 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30401 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30402 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30404 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30405 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30406 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30407 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30408 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30411 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30412 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30414 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30416 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30419 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30420 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30421 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30422 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30425 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30426 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30428 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30429 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30431 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30435 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30436 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30439 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30441 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30442 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30444 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30446 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30451 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30452 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30453 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30454 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30455 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30456 to an incoming message, as in this example:
30458 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30459 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30460 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30462 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30463 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30464 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30465 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30466 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30469 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30470 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30472 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30473 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30474 contains one or more newlines that
30475 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30476 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30477 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30479 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30480 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30481 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30482 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30483 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30484 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30485 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30486 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30487 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30488 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30489 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30491 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30492 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30494 until they are added to the
30495 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30496 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30497 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30498 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30499 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30500 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30501 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30503 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30505 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30506 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30508 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30509 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30511 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30512 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30514 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30515 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30516 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30517 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30520 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30521 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30522 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30523 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30524 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30525 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30526 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30529 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30530 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30531 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30532 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30533 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30535 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30536 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30537 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30538 to be a header name first.) For example:
30540 warn add_header = \
30541 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30543 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30544 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30545 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30546 up in reverse order.
30548 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30549 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30550 system filter or in a router or transport.
30554 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30555 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30556 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30557 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30558 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30559 from an incoming message, as in this example:
30561 warn message = Remove internal headers
30562 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30564 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30565 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30566 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30567 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30568 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30569 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30571 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30572 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30574 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30575 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30576 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30577 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30578 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30580 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30581 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30582 warn message = Remove internal headers
30583 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30585 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30586 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30587 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30588 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30589 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30590 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30591 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30592 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30593 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30594 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30595 would have been removed.
30597 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30598 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30599 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30600 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30601 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30602 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30603 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30604 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30605 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30607 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30608 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30610 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30611 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30613 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30614 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30616 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30617 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30618 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30619 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30622 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30623 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30624 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30629 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30630 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30631 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30632 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30633 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30634 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30636 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30637 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30638 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30639 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30640 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30641 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30642 The conditions are as follows:
30646 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30647 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30648 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30649 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30650 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30651 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30652 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30653 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30654 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30655 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30656 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30657 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30659 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30660 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30661 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30662 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30663 The name and values are expanded separately.
30664 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30665 will act as argument separators.
30667 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30668 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30669 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30670 conditions are tested.
30672 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30673 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30674 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30675 for different local users or different local domains.
30677 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30678 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30679 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30680 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30681 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30682 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30683 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30688 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30689 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30690 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30691 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30692 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30693 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30694 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30695 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30696 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30697 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30698 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30699 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30702 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30703 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30704 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30705 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30706 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30707 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30708 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30709 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30711 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30712 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30713 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30714 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30715 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30716 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30717 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30718 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30719 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30720 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30722 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30723 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30724 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30725 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30726 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30727 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30728 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30729 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30730 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30733 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30734 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30737 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30738 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30739 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30740 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30741 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30742 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30743 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30749 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30750 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30751 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30752 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30753 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30754 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30755 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30757 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30759 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30760 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30761 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30763 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30764 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30765 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30766 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30767 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30768 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30770 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30771 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30773 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30774 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30776 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30777 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30778 statement can then check the IP address.
30780 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30781 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30782 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30783 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30785 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30786 message = $host_data
30788 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30790 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30791 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30792 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30793 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30794 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30795 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30796 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30797 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30798 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30799 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30801 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30802 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30803 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30804 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30805 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30806 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30807 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30809 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30810 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30811 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30812 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30813 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30814 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30815 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30818 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30819 .cindex "rate limiting"
30820 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30821 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30823 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30824 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30825 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30826 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30827 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30828 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30830 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30831 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30832 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30833 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30834 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30835 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30836 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30838 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30839 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30840 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30841 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30842 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30843 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30844 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30845 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30846 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30847 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30848 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30849 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30850 influence the sender checking.
30852 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30853 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30855 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30856 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30857 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30858 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30859 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30860 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30864 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30865 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30867 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30868 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30869 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30870 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30871 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30872 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30874 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30875 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30876 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30877 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30878 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30879 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30880 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30881 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30882 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30883 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30885 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30886 .cindex "CSA verification"
30887 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30888 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30889 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30891 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30892 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30893 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30894 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30895 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30896 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30897 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30898 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30899 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30900 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30902 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30903 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30904 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30906 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30907 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30908 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30909 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30910 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30911 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30912 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30913 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30914 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30915 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30916 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30917 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30918 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30919 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30920 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30922 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30923 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30924 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30925 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30928 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30929 !verify = header_sender
30932 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30933 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30934 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30935 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30936 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30937 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30938 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30939 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30940 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30941 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30942 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30943 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30944 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30947 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30948 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30952 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30953 common as they used to be.
30955 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30956 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30957 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30958 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30959 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30960 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30961 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30962 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30963 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30964 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30965 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30966 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30967 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
30969 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30970 option), this condition is always true.
30973 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
30974 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30975 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30976 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30977 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30978 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30979 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30980 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30981 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30984 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
30985 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
30988 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30989 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30992 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30993 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30994 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30995 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30996 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30997 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30998 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30999 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31000 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31001 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31002 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31003 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31004 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31005 value for the child address.
31007 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31008 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31009 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31010 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31011 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31012 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31013 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31014 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31015 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31016 original IP address.
31018 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31019 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31021 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31022 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31024 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31025 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31026 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31027 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
31028 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
31029 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31030 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31031 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31032 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31034 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31035 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31036 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31037 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31038 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31039 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31040 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31042 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31043 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31044 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31046 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31047 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31048 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31049 verified as a sender.
31051 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31052 (eg. is generated from the received message)
31053 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31055 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31061 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31062 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31063 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31064 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31065 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31066 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31067 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31068 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31069 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31070 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31072 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31073 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31075 the following records are looked up:
31077 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31078 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31080 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31081 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31082 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31083 use two separate conditions:
31085 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31086 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31088 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31089 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31090 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31093 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31094 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31095 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31096 following special items in the list:
31098 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31099 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31100 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31102 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31103 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31104 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31105 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31107 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31109 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31110 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31112 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31113 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31114 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31116 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31118 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31119 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31120 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31121 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31122 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31123 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31125 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31126 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31127 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31131 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31132 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31133 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31134 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31135 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31137 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31139 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31140 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31141 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31142 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31147 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31148 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31149 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31150 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31151 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31152 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31153 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31155 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31156 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31158 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31159 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31160 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31161 up by this example is
31163 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31165 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31166 addresses. For example:
31168 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31169 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31171 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31172 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31177 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31178 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31179 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31180 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31181 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31182 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31183 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31184 either to double the separators like this:
31186 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31188 or to change the separator character, like this:
31190 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31192 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31193 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31194 occurs. Consider this condition:
31196 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31198 The DNS lookups that occur are:
31200 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31201 a.domain.black.list.tld
31203 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31204 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31205 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31206 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31207 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31208 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31209 error for a previous item.
31211 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31212 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31214 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31215 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31217 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31218 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31220 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31221 $sender_address_domain \
31222 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31224 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31225 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31226 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31228 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31229 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31230 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31231 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31233 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31235 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31236 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31238 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31239 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31244 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31245 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31246 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31247 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31248 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31249 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31253 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31255 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31256 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31257 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31259 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31260 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31261 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31264 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31265 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31266 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31267 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31268 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31269 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31270 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31271 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31272 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31273 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31274 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31275 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31276 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31277 cases, for example:
31279 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31281 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31282 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31283 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31284 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31286 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31288 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31289 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31291 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31292 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31293 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31294 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31295 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31298 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31299 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31300 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31302 deny hosts = !+local_networks
31303 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31305 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31310 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31311 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31312 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31313 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31316 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31318 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31319 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31320 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31321 describes how multiple records are handled.
31323 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31324 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31325 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31327 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31329 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31330 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31331 first. For example:
31333 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31334 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31337 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31338 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31339 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31340 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31341 tested. For example:
31343 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31345 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31346 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31347 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31349 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31351 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31356 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31357 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31360 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31362 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31363 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31365 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31367 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31368 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31369 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31370 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31372 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31373 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31375 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31376 previous example is precisely equivalent to
31378 deny dnslists = a.b.c
31379 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31381 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31382 Consider this example:
31384 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31386 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31389 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31391 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31393 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31394 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31395 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31397 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31402 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31403 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31404 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31405 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31406 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31407 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31409 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31411 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31412 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31413 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31414 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31415 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31416 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31419 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31420 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31421 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31423 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31424 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31427 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31429 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31430 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31432 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31434 for the condition to be true.
31437 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31438 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31440 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31441 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31443 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31445 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31446 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31448 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31449 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31451 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31453 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31454 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31456 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31458 for the condition to be false.
31460 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31461 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31466 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31467 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31468 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31469 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31470 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31471 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31472 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31473 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31474 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31477 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31478 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31479 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31480 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31481 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31482 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31483 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31486 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31487 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31489 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31490 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31492 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31493 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31494 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31495 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31496 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31497 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31499 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31500 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31501 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31504 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31505 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31506 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31507 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31509 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31510 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31511 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31515 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31516 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31517 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31518 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31519 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
31520 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31522 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31523 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31525 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31526 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31527 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31529 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31531 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31532 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31534 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31535 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31537 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31538 dnslists = some.list.example
31541 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31542 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31543 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31545 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31548 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31549 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31550 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31551 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31552 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31553 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31554 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31555 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31556 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31557 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31559 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31561 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31562 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31564 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31565 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31566 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31569 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31570 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31571 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31572 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31573 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31574 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31575 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31576 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31577 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31579 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31580 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31581 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31582 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31584 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31585 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31586 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31587 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31588 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31589 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31590 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31591 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31592 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31593 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31595 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31596 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31597 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31600 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31601 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31602 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31603 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31604 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31605 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31607 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31608 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31609 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31610 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31611 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31612 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31613 the &%count=%& option.
31616 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31617 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31618 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31619 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31620 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31622 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31623 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31624 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31625 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31627 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31628 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31629 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31630 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31631 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31632 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31633 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31635 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31636 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31637 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31638 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31639 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31640 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31641 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31643 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31644 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31645 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31646 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31649 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31650 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31651 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31652 multiple different commands.
31654 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31655 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31656 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31657 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31658 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31660 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31663 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31664 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31665 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31666 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31667 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31669 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31670 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31672 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31673 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31674 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31675 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31679 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31680 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31681 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31684 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31685 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31686 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31689 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31690 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31691 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31692 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31693 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31694 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31697 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31698 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31699 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31700 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31701 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31704 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31705 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31706 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31707 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31708 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31709 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31712 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31713 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31714 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31715 up to the given limit.
31716 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31717 consists of refusing the message, and
31718 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31719 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31720 likely not what is wanted.
31722 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31723 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31724 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31725 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31726 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31727 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31728 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31729 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31731 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31735 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31736 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31737 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31738 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31739 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31740 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31741 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31742 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31743 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31745 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31746 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31747 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31748 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31749 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31750 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31752 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31753 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31756 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31757 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31758 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31759 required increases with larger limits.
31761 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31762 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31763 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31764 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31765 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31766 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31767 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31768 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31769 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31773 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31774 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31775 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31776 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31777 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31778 message. For example:
31780 # Log all senders' rates
31781 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31782 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31784 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31785 # at the decimal point.
31786 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31787 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31788 $sender_rate_limit }s
31790 # Keep authenticated users under control
31791 deny authenticated = *
31792 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31794 # System-wide rate limit
31795 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31796 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31798 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31799 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31800 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31801 messages per $sender_rate_period
31802 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31803 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31804 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31806 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31807 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31808 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31809 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31810 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31811 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31812 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31816 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31817 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31818 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31819 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31820 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31821 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31822 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31823 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31824 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31826 verify = sender/callout
31827 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31829 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31830 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31831 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31832 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31833 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31834 The available options are as follows:
31837 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31838 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31839 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31841 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31842 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31843 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31844 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31846 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31847 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31849 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31850 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31851 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31852 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31855 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31856 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31857 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31858 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31859 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31860 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31863 warn !verify = sender
31864 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31866 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31867 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31868 verification failure.
31870 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31871 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31874 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31875 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31877 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31879 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31880 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31881 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31883 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31885 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31888 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31889 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31891 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
31892 address verification to:
31895 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
31901 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31902 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31903 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31904 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31905 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31906 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31907 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31908 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31909 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31910 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31911 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31912 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31915 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31916 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31917 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31918 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31919 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31920 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31922 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31923 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31924 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31925 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31926 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31928 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31929 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31930 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31931 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31932 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31933 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31934 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31935 supplies a host list.
31936 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31938 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31939 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31940 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31941 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31942 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31943 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31944 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31946 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31947 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31948 following SMTP commands are sent:
31950 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31952 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31955 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31958 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31961 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31962 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31963 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31964 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31965 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31966 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31968 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31969 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31970 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31971 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31972 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31974 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31975 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31976 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31977 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31978 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31983 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31984 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31985 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31986 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31988 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31990 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31991 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31992 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31996 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31997 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31998 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32001 verify = sender/callout=5s
32003 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32004 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32005 the &%connect%& parameter.
32008 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32009 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32010 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32011 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32013 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32015 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32017 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
32018 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32019 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32020 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32021 updated in this circumstance.
32023 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32024 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32025 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32026 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32027 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32028 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32031 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32032 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32033 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32034 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32035 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32036 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32037 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32038 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32039 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32040 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32042 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32044 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32047 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32048 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32049 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32052 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32054 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32055 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32056 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32057 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32058 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
32061 .vitem &*no_cache*&
32062 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32063 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32064 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32066 .vitem &*postmaster*&
32067 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32068 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32069 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32070 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32071 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32072 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32073 made, until the cache record expires.
32075 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32076 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32077 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32080 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32082 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32083 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32085 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32087 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32088 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32089 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32090 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32094 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32095 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32096 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32097 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32098 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32100 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32102 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32103 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32104 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32105 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32106 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32108 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32109 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32110 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32112 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32114 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32115 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32116 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32117 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32118 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32120 .vitem &*use_sender*&
32121 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32123 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32125 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32126 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32127 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32128 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32129 usefulness of callout caching.
32132 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32134 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32136 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32137 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32138 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32139 when that is used for the connections.
32140 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32141 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32142 if the use_sender option is used,
32143 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32144 and if no other callouts intervene.
32147 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32148 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32149 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32150 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32151 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32152 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32153 these circumstances.
32155 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32156 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32157 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32158 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32159 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32160 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32161 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32163 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32164 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32165 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32166 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32171 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32172 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32173 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32174 .cindex "caching" "callout"
32175 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32176 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32177 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32178 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32179 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32180 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32182 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32183 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32186 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32187 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32188 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32190 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32191 commands up to and including
32195 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32196 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32197 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32198 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32199 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32200 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32201 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32203 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32204 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32205 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32206 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32207 will eventually be noticed.
32209 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32210 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32211 behaviour will be the same.
32215 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32216 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32217 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32218 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32219 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32220 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32223 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32225 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32226 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32227 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32228 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32229 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32230 550 Sender verification failed
32232 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32233 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32234 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32235 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32238 verify = sender/no_details
32241 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32242 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32243 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32244 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32245 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32246 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32247 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32250 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32251 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32252 verification also fails.
32254 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32255 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32258 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32259 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32260 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32263 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32265 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32266 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32267 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32268 verification to succeed.
32270 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32271 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32272 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32273 option. For example:
32275 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32277 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32278 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32280 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32281 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32282 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32283 address and a report is output for each of them.
32287 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32288 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32289 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32290 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32291 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32292 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32293 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32297 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32298 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32299 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32300 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32301 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32302 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32304 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32305 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32306 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32307 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32310 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32312 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32314 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32315 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32317 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32318 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32321 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32322 use for the DNS query. The default is:
32324 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32326 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32327 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32328 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32329 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32332 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32334 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32335 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32336 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32338 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32339 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32340 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32341 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32342 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32343 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32344 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32345 of legitimate HELO domains.
32347 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32348 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32349 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32350 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32353 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32355 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32356 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32357 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32362 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32363 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
32364 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32365 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32366 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32367 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32368 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32369 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32371 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32372 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32373 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32374 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32375 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32376 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32377 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32378 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32380 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32381 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32384 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32385 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32388 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32389 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32392 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32393 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32395 recipients = +batv_senders
32397 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32398 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32400 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32401 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32402 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32404 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32405 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32406 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32407 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32408 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32410 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32411 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32412 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32413 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32414 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32415 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32416 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32418 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32419 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32420 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32421 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32425 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32427 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32428 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32429 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32432 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32435 external_smtp_batv:
32437 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32438 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32439 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32440 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32443 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32447 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32448 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32449 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32450 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32451 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32452 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32453 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32454 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32455 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32456 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32458 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32459 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32460 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32461 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32462 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32463 same host is fulfilling both functions,
32465 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
32467 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32468 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32469 system to arbitrary domains.
32472 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32473 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32474 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32475 example, suppose you want to do the following:
32478 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32479 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32480 &'my.dom2.example'&.
32482 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32483 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32485 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32486 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32490 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32492 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32493 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32494 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32496 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32500 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32501 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32503 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32504 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32505 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32506 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32507 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32508 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32509 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32513 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32514 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32515 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32516 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32517 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32522 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32523 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32525 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32526 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32527 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32528 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32529 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32530 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32533 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32534 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32535 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32536 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32537 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32539 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32540 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32541 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32544 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32545 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32547 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32548 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32549 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32551 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32552 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32554 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32557 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32560 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32561 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32562 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32563 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32564 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32565 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32567 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32568 temporarily created in a file called:
32570 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32572 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32573 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32574 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32575 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32576 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32578 control = no_mbox_unspool
32580 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32581 same directory by default.
32585 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32586 .cindex "virus scanning"
32587 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32588 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32589 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32590 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32591 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32592 in memory and thus are much faster.
32594 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32595 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32597 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32598 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32599 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32600 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32602 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32604 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32606 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32608 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32610 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32611 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32612 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32616 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32617 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32618 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32619 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32620 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32621 This scanner type takes one option,
32622 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32623 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32624 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32625 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32626 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32627 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32628 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32630 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32631 If &`pass_unscanned`&
32632 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32633 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32638 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32639 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32640 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32642 If you omit the argument, the default path
32643 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32645 If you use a remote host,
32646 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32647 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32648 For information about available commands and their options you may use
32650 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32656 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32657 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32658 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32660 .vitem &%aveserver%&
32661 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32662 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32663 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32664 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32667 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32672 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32673 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32674 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32675 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32676 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32678 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32679 a UNIX socket specification,
32680 a TCP socket specification,
32681 or a (global) option.
32683 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32684 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32685 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32686 and the second a port number,
32687 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32688 These per-server options are supported:
32690 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32693 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32694 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32696 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32700 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32701 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32702 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32703 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32704 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32706 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32708 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32709 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32710 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32711 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32713 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32714 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32715 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32716 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32717 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32718 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32719 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32720 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32721 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32723 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32724 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32725 (Connection refused)
32728 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32729 contributing the code for this scanner.
32732 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32733 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32734 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32735 type takes 3 mandatory options:
32738 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32739 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32742 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32743 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32744 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32745 the &"trigger"& expression.
32748 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32749 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32750 &"name"& expression.
32753 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32755 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32757 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32758 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32759 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32760 configuration setting:
32762 av_scanner = cmdline:\
32763 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32764 found in file:'(.+)'
32767 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32768 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32770 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32771 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32772 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32773 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32776 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32777 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32779 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32780 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32783 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32784 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32785 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32789 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32791 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32793 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32794 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32795 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32796 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32799 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32801 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32804 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32805 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32806 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32808 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32810 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32811 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32813 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32814 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32815 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32816 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32817 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32820 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32822 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32825 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32826 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
32827 though some documentation was available in English.
32828 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
32829 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
32830 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
32832 The only option for this scanner type is
32833 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32834 provided that mksd has
32835 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32837 av_scanner = mksd:2
32839 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32842 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32843 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32844 running on the local machine.
32845 There are four options:
32846 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32847 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32848 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32849 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32850 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32853 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32855 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32856 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32857 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32858 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32859 specify an empty element to get this.
32862 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32863 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32864 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
32865 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32866 client communication. For example:
32868 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32870 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32874 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32875 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32878 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32879 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32880 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32881 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32882 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32883 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32886 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32887 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32888 The first element can then be one of
32891 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32892 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32895 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32896 the condition fails immediately.
32898 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32899 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32900 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32901 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32902 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
32905 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32906 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32907 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32909 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32910 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32913 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32915 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32917 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32918 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32919 is set to record the actual address used.
32921 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32922 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32923 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32924 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32927 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32928 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32930 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32932 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32935 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32937 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32938 malware = */defer_ok
32940 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32941 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32943 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32945 in the main Exim configuration.
32947 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32948 set acl_m0 = sophie
32951 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32952 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32957 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32958 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32959 .cindex "spam scanning"
32960 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32962 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32963 score and a report for the message.
32964 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32966 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32967 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32968 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
32970 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32972 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32974 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32975 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32978 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32979 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32980 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32981 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32982 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32983 configuration as follows (example):
32985 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
32987 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32988 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32989 iptables firewall, consider setting
32990 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32991 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32992 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32993 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32997 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32999 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33001 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33004 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33005 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33006 filename instead of an address/port pair:
33008 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33010 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33011 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33012 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33013 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33015 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33016 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33019 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33020 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33021 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33024 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33025 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33026 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33027 take care to not double the separator.
33029 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33030 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33031 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33032 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33034 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33036 The supported options are:
33038 pri=<priority> Selection priority
33039 weight=<value> Selection bias
33040 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33041 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33042 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33043 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33046 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33047 higher values being tried first.
33048 The default priority is 1.
33050 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33051 Within a priority set
33052 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33053 The default value for selection bias is 1.
33055 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33056 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33057 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33058 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33060 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33061 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33063 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33064 The default value is two minutes.
33066 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33067 a failed connect is made.
33068 The default is to not retry.
33070 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33071 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33072 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33075 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33076 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33077 is set to record the actual address used.
33079 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33080 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33082 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33085 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33086 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33087 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33088 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33089 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33092 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33093 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33094 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33095 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33096 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33098 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33099 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33101 or the use of PRDR,
33102 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33103 are needed to use this feature.
33105 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33106 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33107 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33110 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33111 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33112 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33115 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33116 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33120 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33121 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33122 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33123 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33125 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33126 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33128 Except for &$spam_report$&,
33129 these variables are saved with the received message so are
33130 available for use at delivery time.
33133 .vitem &$spam_score$&
33134 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33135 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33137 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33138 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33139 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33140 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33141 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33143 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
33144 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33145 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33146 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33147 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33148 spam bar is 50 characters.
33150 .vitem &$spam_report$&
33151 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33152 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33153 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33154 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33155 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33156 unencoded in headers.
33158 .vitem &$spam_action$&
33159 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33160 spam score versus threshold.
33161 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33165 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33166 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33167 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33169 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33170 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33171 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33172 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33173 spam condition, like this:
33175 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33176 spam = joe/defer_ok
33178 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33180 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33183 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33184 warn spam = nobody:true
33185 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33186 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33188 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33189 # is over threshold
33191 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33193 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33194 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33196 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33201 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33202 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33203 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
33204 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33205 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33206 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33207 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33208 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33209 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33210 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33213 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33214 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33215 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33216 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33217 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33218 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33219 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33221 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33222 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33223 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33224 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33225 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33227 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33228 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33229 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33230 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33231 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33234 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33236 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33240 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33242 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33243 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33244 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33245 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33247 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33248 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33249 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33250 the full path and filename.
33252 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33253 filename, and the default path is then used.
33255 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33256 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33257 a file with its original, proposed filename using
33259 decode = $mime_filename
33261 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33262 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33263 automatically unlinked.
33265 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33266 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33267 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33268 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33269 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33271 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33272 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33273 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33275 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33276 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33277 available in the MIME ACL:
33280 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33281 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33282 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33283 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33284 contains the empty string.
33286 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
33287 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33288 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33294 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33295 case-insensitively.
33297 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33298 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33299 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33300 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33301 only used for display purposes.
33303 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33304 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33305 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33307 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33308 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33309 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33311 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33312 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33313 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33314 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33315 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33317 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33318 This variable contains the normalized content of the
33319 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33320 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33322 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33323 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33324 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33325 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33329 application/octet-stream
33333 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33336 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33337 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33338 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33339 containing the decoded data.
33344 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
33345 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33346 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33347 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33350 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33352 found, this variable contains the empty string.
33354 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33355 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33356 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33357 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33359 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33360 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33364 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33367 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33368 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33371 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33372 and the rest are attachments.
33375 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33378 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33379 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33380 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33382 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33383 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33384 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33385 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33387 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33388 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33389 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33390 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33391 want to carry out specific actions on them.
33393 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33394 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33395 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33396 decoding is fully recursive.
33398 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33399 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33400 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33401 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33402 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33403 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33404 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33409 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33410 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33411 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33412 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33413 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33415 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33416 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33417 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33418 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33419 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33421 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33422 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33423 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33424 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33425 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
33426 32K characters are checked.
33428 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33429 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33430 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33431 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33432 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33434 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33435 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33437 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33438 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33439 matching regular expression.
33440 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33441 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33443 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33451 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33452 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33454 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33455 "Local scan function"
33456 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33457 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33458 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33459 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33460 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33462 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33463 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33464 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33465 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33466 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33468 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33469 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33470 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33471 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33473 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33474 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33475 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33476 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33478 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33479 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33480 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33481 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33482 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33483 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33484 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33485 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33486 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33490 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33491 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33492 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33493 function is before building Exim, by setting
33494 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33495 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33496 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33497 directory, so you might set
33499 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33500 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33502 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
33503 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33504 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33505 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33506 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33507 _src/local_scan.c_.
33509 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33510 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33512 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33514 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33519 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33520 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33521 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33522 You must include this line near the start of your code:
33524 #include "local_scan.h"
33526 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33527 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33528 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33529 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33530 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33531 strings and pointers to character strings:
33533 #define CS (char *)
33534 #define CCS (const char *)
33535 #define CSS (char **)
33536 #define US (unsigned char *)
33537 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33538 #define USS (unsigned char **)
33540 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33542 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33544 The arguments are as follows:
33547 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33548 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33549 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33551 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33552 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33553 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33554 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33555 case this changes in some future version.
33557 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33558 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33561 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33564 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33565 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33566 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33567 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33568 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33569 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33571 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33572 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33573 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33575 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33576 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33577 queued without immediate delivery.
33579 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33580 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33581 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33582 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33583 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33586 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33587 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33588 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33591 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33592 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33593 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33594 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33595 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33596 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33597 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33599 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33600 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33601 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33604 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33605 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33606 &%-oe%& command line options.
33610 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33611 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33612 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33613 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33614 want to do this, you must have the line
33616 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33618 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33619 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33620 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33623 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33624 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33625 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33626 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33627 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33628 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33630 static int my_integer_option = 42;
33631 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33633 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33634 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33635 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33638 int local_scan_options_count =
33639 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33641 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33642 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33646 my_string = some string of text...
33648 The available types of option data are as follows:
33651 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
33652 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33653 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33654 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33655 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33656 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33659 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33660 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33661 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33662 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33665 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33666 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33669 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33670 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33671 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33672 printed with the suffix K or M.
33674 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
33675 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33676 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33677 always output in octal.
33679 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33680 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33681 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33683 .vitem &*opt_time*&
33684 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33685 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33688 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33689 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33693 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33694 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33695 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33696 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33697 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33698 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33699 C variables are as follows:
33702 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33703 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33704 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33706 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33707 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33708 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33710 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33711 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33712 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33713 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33716 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33717 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33718 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33721 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33722 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33726 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33727 selected, you should use code like this:
33729 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33730 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33732 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33733 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33734 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33736 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33737 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33740 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33741 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33743 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33744 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33746 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33747 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33748 &%-bh%& command line option.
33750 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33751 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33752 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33754 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33755 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33756 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33757 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33759 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33760 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33761 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33763 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33764 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33766 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33767 The number of accepted recipients.
33769 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33770 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33771 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33772 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33773 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33774 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33775 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33776 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33777 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33778 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33779 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33780 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33782 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33783 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33785 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33786 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33787 locally-submitted messages.
33789 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33790 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33791 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33793 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33794 The name of the sending host, if known.
33796 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33797 The port on the sending host.
33799 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33800 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33802 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33803 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33805 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33806 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33807 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33811 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33812 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33813 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33814 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33819 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33820 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33822 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33823 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33824 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33825 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33826 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33827 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33828 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33830 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33831 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33834 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33835 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33836 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33841 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33842 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33845 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33846 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33848 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33849 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33850 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33851 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33853 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33854 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33855 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33856 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33857 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33858 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33859 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33860 is NULL for all recipients.
33865 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33866 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33867 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33868 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33872 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33873 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33875 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33876 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33877 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33878 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33880 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33881 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33882 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33883 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33884 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33886 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33888 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33889 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33890 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33891 return value is as follows:
33896 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33902 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33908 The process timed out.
33912 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33915 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33916 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33917 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33918 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33919 forks a subprocess that is running
33921 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33923 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33924 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33925 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33926 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33928 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33929 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33930 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33931 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33934 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33935 *sender_authentication)*&
33936 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33939 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33941 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33944 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33945 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33946 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33947 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33948 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33950 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33951 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33954 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33955 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33956 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33957 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33958 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33959 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33960 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33961 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33963 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33964 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33965 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33966 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33967 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33968 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33970 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33971 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33972 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33973 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33975 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33976 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33977 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33978 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33979 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33980 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33981 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33982 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33983 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33984 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33986 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33987 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33989 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33990 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33993 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33994 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33995 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33996 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33997 match the specification, the function does nothing.
34000 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34001 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34002 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34003 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34004 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34005 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34007 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34009 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34010 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34011 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34012 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34013 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34016 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34017 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34018 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34019 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34020 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34021 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34022 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34023 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34025 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34026 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34027 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34029 &`OK `& match succeeded
34030 &`FAIL `& match failed
34031 &`DEFER `& match deferred
34033 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34034 inability to contact a database.
34036 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34038 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34039 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34040 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34042 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34044 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34045 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34046 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34048 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34050 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34053 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34055 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34056 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34057 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34058 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34059 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34060 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34063 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34065 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34066 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34067 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34068 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34069 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34070 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34073 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34074 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34075 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34076 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34078 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34079 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34080 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34081 value afterwards. For example:
34083 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34084 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34085 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34088 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34089 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34090 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34091 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34098 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34099 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34100 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34101 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34102 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34103 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34104 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34105 binary string is returned with an error message.
34107 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34108 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34109 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34111 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34112 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34113 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34114 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34115 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34117 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34118 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34119 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34121 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34122 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34123 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34124 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34128 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34129 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34132 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34133 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34134 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34135 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34136 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34137 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34138 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34139 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34142 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34143 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34145 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34146 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34147 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34148 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34149 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34150 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34151 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34153 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34154 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34156 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34157 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34158 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34159 multiple output lines.
34161 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34162 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
34163 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34164 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34165 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34166 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34167 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34170 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
34171 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34172 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
34173 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34175 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
34176 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34177 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34179 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34182 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34185 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34186 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34187 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34188 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34189 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34190 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34196 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34197 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34198 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34199 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34200 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34201 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34202 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34205 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34206 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34207 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34208 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34210 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34211 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34213 store_pool = POOL_PERM
34215 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34216 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34217 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34218 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34220 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34221 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34222 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34223 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34231 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34233 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34234 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34235 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34236 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34237 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34238 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34239 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34240 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34242 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34243 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34244 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34245 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34246 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34248 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34249 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34250 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34251 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34252 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34253 prevent it happening on retries.
34255 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34256 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34257 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34258 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34259 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34260 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34261 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34262 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34265 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34266 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34267 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34268 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34269 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34270 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34271 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34273 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34274 system_filter_user = exim
34276 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34277 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34278 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34279 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34280 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34281 by the &%reply%& command.
34284 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34285 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34286 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34287 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34289 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34290 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34294 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34295 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34296 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34297 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34298 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34299 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34302 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34303 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34304 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34305 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34306 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34307 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34308 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34310 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34311 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34312 succeed, it will not be tried again.
34313 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34314 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34316 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34317 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34318 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34319 to which users' filter files can refer.
34323 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34324 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
34325 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34326 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34327 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34331 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34332 .cindex "freezing messages"
34333 .cindex "message" "freezing"
34334 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
34335 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34336 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34337 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34338 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34339 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34340 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34341 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34342 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34344 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34346 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34348 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34349 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34350 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34351 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34352 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34355 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34356 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34357 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34358 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34360 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34361 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34362 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34363 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34364 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34365 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34366 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34367 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34368 message. For example:
34370 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34371 because it contains attachments that we are \
34372 not prepared to receive."
34375 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34376 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34377 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34378 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34379 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34380 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34383 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34384 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34386 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34387 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34388 generated by the filter.
34390 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34392 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34393 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34399 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34400 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34405 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34406 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34407 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34408 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34409 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34411 headers add <string>
34412 headers remove <string>
34414 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34415 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34416 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34417 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34418 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34420 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34421 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34422 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34425 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34426 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34429 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34430 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34431 space after input continuations is ignored.
34433 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34434 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34435 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34436 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34437 header with the same name, they are all removed.
34439 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34440 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34441 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34442 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34443 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34444 used for all recipients of the message.
34446 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34447 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34448 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34449 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34450 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34451 until the message is actually being written (see section
34452 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34454 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34455 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34456 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34457 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34458 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34459 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34460 modified more than once.
34462 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34463 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34466 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34467 headers remove "Subject"
34468 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34469 headers remove "Old-Subject"
34474 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34475 .cindex "envelope from"
34476 .cindex "envelope sender"
34477 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34479 errors_to <some address>
34481 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34482 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34483 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34486 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34488 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34489 address if its delivery failed.
34493 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34494 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34495 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34496 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34497 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34498 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34499 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34500 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34501 which implements such a filter:
34506 domains = +local_domains
34507 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34512 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34513 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34514 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34515 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34517 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34518 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34519 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34520 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34522 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
34523 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
34524 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
34531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34532 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34534 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34535 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34536 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34537 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34538 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34539 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34540 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34541 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34543 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34544 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34545 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34546 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34547 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34549 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34550 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34551 loopback interface specially in any way.
34553 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34554 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34559 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34560 .cindex "message" "submission"
34561 .cindex "submission mode"
34562 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34563 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34564 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34565 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34567 control = submission
34569 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34570 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34571 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34572 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34573 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34574 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34576 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34577 control = submission
34579 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34580 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34581 is used to separate options. For example:
34583 control = submission/sender_retain
34585 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34586 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34587 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34588 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34589 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34590 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34591 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34593 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34594 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34597 control = submission/domain=some.domain
34599 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34600 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34601 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34602 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34604 accept authenticated = *
34605 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34606 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34607 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34609 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34610 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34611 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34613 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34615 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34618 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34620 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34621 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34622 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34623 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34625 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34626 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34627 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34628 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34629 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34630 spoof another's address.
34632 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34633 .cindex "line endings"
34634 .cindex "carriage return"
34636 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34637 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34638 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34639 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34640 use CRLF or just CR.
34642 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34643 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34644 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34645 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34646 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34647 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34648 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34649 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34653 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34655 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34658 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34659 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34662 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34663 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34664 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34665 people trying to play silly games.
34667 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34668 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34676 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34677 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
34678 .cindex "address" "qualification"
34679 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34680 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34681 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34682 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34683 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34685 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34686 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34687 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34688 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34689 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34691 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34692 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34693 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34694 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34695 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34696 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34697 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34698 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34703 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34704 .cindex "&""From""& line"
34705 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34706 .cindex "sender" "address"
34707 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34708 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34709 .cindex "envelope from"
34710 .cindex "envelope sender"
34711 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34712 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34713 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34714 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34716 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34717 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34719 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34720 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34721 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34722 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34723 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34724 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34725 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34726 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34727 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34729 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34730 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34731 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34732 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34733 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34734 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34735 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34737 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34738 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34739 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34741 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34742 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34743 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34744 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34748 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34749 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34750 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34751 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34752 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34753 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34754 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34755 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34758 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34759 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34762 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34763 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34767 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34768 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34770 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34771 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34772 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34774 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34777 For a locally-submitted message,
34778 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34779 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34780 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34781 included in log lines in this case.
34783 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34784 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34790 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34791 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34792 includes the header line:
34794 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34797 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34798 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34799 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34800 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34801 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34802 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34805 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34806 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34807 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34808 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34809 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34810 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34812 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34813 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34814 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34815 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34816 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34817 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34818 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34819 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34823 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34824 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34825 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34826 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34827 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34828 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34829 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34830 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34831 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34835 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34836 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34837 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34838 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34839 .cindex "message" "submission"
34840 .cindex "submission mode"
34841 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34842 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34845 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34846 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34848 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34849 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34851 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34852 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34853 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34855 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34856 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34858 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34859 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34863 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34865 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34866 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34867 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34868 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34869 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34870 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34871 &%qualify_domain%&.
34873 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34874 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34875 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34876 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34879 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34880 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34881 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34882 .cindex "message" "submission"
34883 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34884 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34885 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34886 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34887 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34888 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34889 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34890 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34891 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34892 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34895 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34896 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34897 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34898 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34899 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34900 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34902 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34903 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34904 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34905 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34907 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34908 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34909 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34912 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34913 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34914 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34915 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34916 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34917 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34918 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34919 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34920 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34921 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34922 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34923 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34927 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34928 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34929 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34930 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34931 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34932 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34933 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34934 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34935 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34939 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34940 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34941 .cindex "message" "submission"
34942 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34943 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34944 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34945 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34946 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34949 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34950 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34951 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34952 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34953 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34954 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34955 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34956 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34957 line is added to the message.
34959 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34960 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34961 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34962 options true at the same time.
34964 .cindex "submission mode"
34965 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34966 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34967 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34968 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34970 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34971 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34972 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34973 created as follows:
34976 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34977 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34978 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34980 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34981 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34983 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34984 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34987 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34988 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34989 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34990 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34992 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34993 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34994 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34995 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34999 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35000 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35001 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35002 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35003 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35004 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35005 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35006 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35007 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35009 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35010 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35011 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35012 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35013 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35014 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35016 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35017 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35018 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35020 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35021 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35022 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35024 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35025 X-added-second: another added header line
35027 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35029 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35030 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35031 Each header-line is separately expanded.
35033 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35034 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35035 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35036 not part of the names. For example:
35038 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35041 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35042 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35043 Each item is separately expanded.
35044 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35045 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35046 will act as list separators.
35048 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35049 items are expanded at routing time,
35050 and then associated with all addresses that are
35051 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35052 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35053 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35055 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
35056 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35057 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35058 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35060 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35061 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35062 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35065 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35066 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35067 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35068 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35069 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35070 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35071 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35073 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35074 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35075 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35076 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35078 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35079 the following consequences:
35082 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35083 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35084 to it, at all times.
35086 Header lines that are added by a router's
35087 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35088 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35090 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35091 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35093 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35094 a later router or by a transport.
35096 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35097 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35099 headers_remove = subject
35100 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35104 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35105 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35111 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35112 .cindex "address" "constructed"
35113 .cindex "constructed address"
35114 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35117 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35121 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35123 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35124 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35125 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35126 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35127 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35128 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35129 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35130 there is no password file entry.
35133 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35134 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35135 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35136 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35137 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35138 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35139 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35140 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35144 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35145 .cindex "case of local parts"
35146 .cindex "local part" "case of"
35147 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35148 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35149 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35150 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35151 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35152 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35155 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
35156 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35157 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35158 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35159 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35163 domains = +local_domains
35164 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35165 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35168 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35169 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35170 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35171 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35172 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35176 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35177 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
35178 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
35179 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35180 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35181 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35182 empty components for compatibility.
35186 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35187 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35188 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35189 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35190 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35191 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35193 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35194 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35195 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35196 example, a header such as
35200 might get rewritten as
35202 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35204 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35205 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35208 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35209 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35210 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35211 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35212 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35213 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35214 .ecindex IIDmesproc
35218 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35221 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35222 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35223 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35224 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35225 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35226 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35227 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35230 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35232 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35234 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35237 For mail delivery, the following are available:
35240 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35242 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35245 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35248 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35249 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35252 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35253 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35254 used to contain the envelope information.
35258 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35259 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35260 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35261 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35262 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35265 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35266 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35267 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35268 processing is the same in both cases.
35270 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35271 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35272 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35273 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35274 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35275 .cindex "transport" "filter"
35276 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35277 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35280 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35281 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35282 required for the transaction.
35284 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35285 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35286 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35287 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35288 is called for verification.
35290 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35291 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35292 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35294 .cindex "carriage return"
35296 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35297 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35298 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35301 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35302 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35303 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35304 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35305 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35306 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35307 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35308 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35309 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35311 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35312 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35313 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35314 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35316 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35317 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35318 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35319 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35321 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35322 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35323 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35324 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35325 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35326 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35327 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35328 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35329 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35330 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35332 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35333 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35335 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35336 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35337 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35338 square bracket of the IP address.
35343 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35344 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35345 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35346 .cindex "host" "error"
35347 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35348 message errors, and recipient errors.
35351 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35352 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35353 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35356 Connection refused or timed out,
35358 Any error response code on connection,
35360 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35362 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35364 I/O errors at any time,
35366 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35367 the &"."& at the end of the data.
35370 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35371 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35372 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35373 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35374 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35375 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35376 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35377 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35379 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35380 .cindex "message" "error"
35381 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35382 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35383 message errors are:
35386 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35389 Timeout after MAIL,
35391 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35392 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35393 connection at any other time.
35396 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35397 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35398 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35399 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35400 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35401 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35402 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35403 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35404 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35405 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35407 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35408 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35409 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35412 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35413 .cindex "recipient" "error"
35414 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35415 recipient errors are:
35418 Any error response to RCPT,
35420 Timeout after RCPT.
35423 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35424 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35425 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35426 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35427 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35428 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35429 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35430 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35431 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35432 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35433 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35434 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35435 the retry clock is reset.
35437 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35438 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35439 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35440 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35441 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35442 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35443 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35444 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35445 recipient's retry time.
35448 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35449 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35450 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35451 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35452 until the next delivery attempt.
35454 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35455 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35456 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35457 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35458 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35461 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35462 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35463 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35464 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35465 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35466 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35467 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35469 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35470 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35471 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35472 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35473 then to be treated as a host error.
35475 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35476 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35477 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35478 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35479 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35484 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35485 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35486 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35489 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35490 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35491 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35493 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35495 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35496 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35497 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35498 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35499 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35500 stream and exits with an error code.
35502 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35503 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35504 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35505 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35507 .cindex "carriage return"
35509 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35510 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35511 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35513 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35514 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35515 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35517 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35518 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35519 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35520 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35521 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35522 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35523 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35524 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35526 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35527 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35528 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35529 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35530 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35531 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35532 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35533 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35534 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35536 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35537 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35538 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35540 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35541 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35542 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35543 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35544 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35546 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35547 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35548 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35549 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35550 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35551 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35552 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35554 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35555 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35556 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35557 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35558 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35560 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35561 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35562 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35563 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35564 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35565 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35566 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35567 a delivery process.
35569 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35570 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35571 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35572 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35573 however, available with &'inetd'&.
35575 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35576 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35577 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35578 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35580 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35581 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35582 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35586 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35587 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35588 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35589 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35590 the error response to the last command. The default value for
35591 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35592 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35593 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35596 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35597 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35598 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35599 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35600 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35601 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35602 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35603 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35604 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35605 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35606 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35610 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35611 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35612 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35613 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35614 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35615 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35616 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35617 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35619 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35620 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35621 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35622 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35623 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35626 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35627 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35628 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35630 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35631 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35632 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35633 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35634 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35639 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35640 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35641 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35642 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35644 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35645 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35646 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35647 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
35648 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35649 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35650 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35651 SMTP response codes.
35653 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35654 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35655 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35656 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35657 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35658 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35659 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35660 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35665 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35666 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35667 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35668 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35669 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35670 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35671 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35673 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35674 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35675 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35676 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35677 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35678 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35679 argument. For example,
35687 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35688 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35689 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35690 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35691 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35693 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35694 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35695 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35696 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35697 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35698 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35699 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35700 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35702 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35703 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35704 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35705 whatever the form of its argument. For
35708 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35709 $sender_host_address
35711 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35712 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35713 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35714 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35715 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35716 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35717 for it to change them before running the command.
35721 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35722 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35723 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35724 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35725 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35726 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35727 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35728 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35729 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35730 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35731 runs for RCPT commands:
35735 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35739 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35740 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35741 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
35742 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35743 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35744 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35745 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35746 envelope along with the message.
35748 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35749 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35750 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35751 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35752 can be used to specify it.
35754 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35755 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35756 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35757 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35758 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35761 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35762 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35763 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35768 driver = manualroute
35769 transport = smtp_appendfile
35770 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35774 driver = appendfile
35775 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35780 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35781 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35782 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35786 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35787 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35788 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
35789 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35790 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35791 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35792 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35793 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35794 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35795 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35797 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35798 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35800 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35801 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35802 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35803 make some use of automatically, for example:
35805 554 Unexpected end of file
35806 Transaction started in line 10
35807 Error detected in line 14
35809 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35812 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35813 The error message was:
35815 501 '>' missing at end of address
35817 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35818 The error was detected in line 12.
35819 The SMTP command at fault was:
35821 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35823 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35824 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35826 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35827 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35829 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35830 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35834 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35835 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35837 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35838 "Customizing messages"
35839 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
35840 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35841 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35842 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35843 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35845 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35846 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35847 option. Exim also adds the line
35849 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35851 to all warning and bounce messages,
35854 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35855 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35856 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35857 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35858 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35859 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35860 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35862 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35863 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35864 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35865 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35866 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35869 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35870 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35871 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35872 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35873 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35874 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35875 option, rounded to a whole number.
35877 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35880 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35881 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35883 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35884 failing addresses with their error messages.
35886 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35887 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35889 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35890 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35893 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35894 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35895 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35897 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35898 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35899 {: returning message to sender}}
35901 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35903 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35904 {that you sent }{sent by
35908 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35909 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35911 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35913 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35916 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35918 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35921 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35922 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35923 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35924 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35925 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35929 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35930 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35932 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35933 the delayed addresses.
35935 The third item then ends the message.
35938 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35939 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35941 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35942 $warn_message_delay
35944 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35946 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35947 {that you sent }{sent by
35951 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35952 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
35954 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35955 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35956 The date of the message is: $h_date
35958 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35960 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35961 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35962 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35963 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35964 the message will be returned to you.
35966 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35967 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35968 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35969 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35970 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35971 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35972 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35973 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35979 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35980 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35982 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35983 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35984 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35988 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35989 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35990 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35991 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35992 routing explicitly:
35994 send_to_smart_host:
35995 driver = manualroute
35996 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35997 transport = remote_smtp
35999 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36000 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36001 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36002 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36003 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36008 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36009 .cindex "mailing lists"
36010 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36011 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36012 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36014 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36015 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36016 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36017 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36021 domains = lists.example
36022 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36025 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36028 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36029 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36030 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36031 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36033 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36034 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36037 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36038 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36039 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36040 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36041 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36043 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36044 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36045 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36046 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36047 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36048 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36049 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36050 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36051 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36055 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36056 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36057 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36058 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36059 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36060 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36061 addresses are not rigorously checked.
36063 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36064 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36065 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36066 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36067 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36071 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36072 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36073 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36074 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36075 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36076 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36077 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36078 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36079 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36080 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36082 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36083 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36084 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36085 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36086 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36087 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36088 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36089 pre-existing messages.
36091 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36092 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36093 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36094 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36095 one level of expansion anyway.
36099 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36100 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36101 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36102 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36103 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36104 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36106 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36107 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36111 domains = lists.example
36112 local_part_suffix = -request
36113 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36118 domains = lists.example
36119 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36120 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36121 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36124 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36129 domains = lists.example
36131 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36133 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36134 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36135 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36138 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36139 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36140 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36141 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36142 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36143 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36144 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36145 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36146 &"unrouteable address"& error.
36148 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36149 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36150 the address, giving a suitable error message.
36155 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36157 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36158 .cindex "envelope from"
36159 .cindex "envelope sender"
36160 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36161 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36162 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36163 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36164 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36165 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36167 .oindex &%errors_to%&
36168 .oindex &%return_path%&
36169 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36170 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36171 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36172 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36173 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36174 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36175 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36181 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36182 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36184 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36185 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36186 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36187 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36188 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36189 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36190 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36193 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36195 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36196 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36197 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36198 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36199 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36200 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36202 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36203 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36204 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36205 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36209 domains = ! +local_domains
36211 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36212 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36215 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36216 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36217 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36218 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36221 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36222 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36223 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36224 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36225 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36229 domains = ! +local_domains
36230 transport = remote_smtp
36232 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36233 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36236 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36237 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36238 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36239 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36242 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36243 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36244 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36245 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36246 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36247 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36255 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36256 .cindex "virtual domains"
36257 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
36258 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36262 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36263 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36264 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36266 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36267 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36268 have login accounts on that host.
36271 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36272 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36273 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36274 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36275 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36276 to a router of this form:
36280 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36281 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36284 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36285 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36286 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36287 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36288 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36289 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36291 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36292 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36293 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36294 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36296 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36297 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36298 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36302 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36303 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36304 transport = my_mailboxes
36306 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36307 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36308 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36309 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36310 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36314 driver = appendfile
36315 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36318 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36319 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36321 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36322 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36323 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36324 information about the domains.
36328 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36329 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36330 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36331 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
36332 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
36333 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36334 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36335 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36336 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36337 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36338 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36339 example, consider this router:
36344 file = $home/.forward
36345 local_part_suffix = -*
36346 local_part_suffix_optional
36349 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36350 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36351 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36352 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36354 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36355 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36358 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36359 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36360 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36361 control over which suffixes are valid.
36363 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36364 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36370 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36371 local_part_suffix = -*
36372 local_part_suffix_optional
36375 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36376 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36377 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36378 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36379 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36383 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36384 .cindex "vacation processing"
36385 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36386 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36387 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36388 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36389 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36392 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36393 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36394 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36395 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36397 spqr, vacation-spqr
36400 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36401 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36402 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36403 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36404 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36408 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36409 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36413 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36414 .cindex "message" "copying every"
36415 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36416 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36417 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36418 each day's messages.
36420 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36421 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36422 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36423 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36427 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36428 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36429 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36430 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36431 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36432 permanently connected.
36434 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36435 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36436 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36439 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36440 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36441 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36442 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36443 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36444 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36445 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36446 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36448 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36449 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36450 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36451 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36452 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36453 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36456 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36457 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36458 intermittent host. For example:
36460 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36462 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36463 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36464 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36465 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36466 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36467 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36470 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36471 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36472 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36473 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36474 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36475 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36476 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36480 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36481 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36482 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36483 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36484 delivered immediately.
36486 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36487 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36488 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36489 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36490 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36491 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36492 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36493 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36494 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36495 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36496 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36497 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36498 single SMTP connection.
36502 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36503 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36505 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36506 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36507 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
36508 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36509 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36510 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36511 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36512 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36513 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36514 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36517 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36518 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36519 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36520 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36521 email is not desirable.
36523 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36524 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36525 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36526 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36527 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36528 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36529 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36531 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36532 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36533 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36534 before sending a message to the smart host.
36536 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36537 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36538 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36540 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36541 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36542 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36543 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36544 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36545 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36546 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36548 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36552 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36553 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36555 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36556 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36557 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36558 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36559 successful, a zero return code is given.
36561 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36562 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36563 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36564 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36565 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36568 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36569 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36570 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36572 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36573 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36574 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36575 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36576 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36578 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36579 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36580 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36582 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36583 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36584 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36585 are ever generated.
36587 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36589 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36590 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36591 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36594 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36595 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36596 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36597 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36598 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36599 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36604 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36605 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36607 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36608 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36609 .cindex "log" "types of"
36610 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36615 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36616 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36617 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36618 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36619 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36620 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36621 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36622 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36624 .cindex "reject log"
36625 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36626 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36627 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36628 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36629 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36630 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36631 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36632 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36633 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36636 .cindex "panic log"
36637 .cindex "system log"
36638 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36639 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36640 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36641 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36642 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36643 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36644 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36645 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36646 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36649 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36650 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36651 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36653 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36656 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36657 ways of changing this:
36660 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36665 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36667 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36670 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36674 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36675 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36676 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36677 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36678 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36679 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36684 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36685 .cindex "log" "destination"
36686 .cindex "log" "to file"
36687 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
36689 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36690 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36691 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36692 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36693 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36694 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36695 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36697 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36698 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36699 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36700 references to the host name:
36702 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36704 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36705 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36706 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36707 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36708 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36711 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36712 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36713 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36714 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36715 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36716 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36717 implying the use of a default path.
36719 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36720 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36721 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36722 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36723 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36724 equivalent to the setting:
36726 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36728 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36729 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36730 that is where the logs are written.
36732 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
36733 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36735 Here are some examples of possible settings:
36737 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36738 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36739 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36740 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36742 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36747 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36748 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36749 .cindex "cycling logs"
36750 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36751 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36752 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36753 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36754 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36755 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36756 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36758 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36759 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36760 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36761 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36762 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36763 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36764 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36765 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36766 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36767 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36768 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36773 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36774 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36775 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36776 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36777 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36778 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36779 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36780 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36782 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36783 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36784 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36785 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36787 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36788 examples of names generated by the above examples:
36790 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36791 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36792 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36793 /var/log/exim/main.200212
36795 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36796 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36797 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36798 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36800 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36801 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36802 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36803 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36804 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36805 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36808 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36809 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36810 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36811 /var/log/exim/panic
36815 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36816 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36817 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36818 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36819 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36820 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36821 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36822 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36823 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36824 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36825 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36826 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36827 the time and host name to each line.
36828 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36831 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36833 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36835 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36838 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36839 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36840 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36841 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36843 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36844 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36845 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36846 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36847 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36848 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36849 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36850 RFC 3164, you should set
36852 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36854 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36855 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36857 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36858 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36859 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36860 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36861 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36862 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36863 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36864 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36865 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36867 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36868 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36869 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36870 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36873 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36876 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36877 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36878 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36879 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36881 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36882 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36883 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36884 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36885 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36886 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36888 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36889 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36890 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36893 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36895 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36896 without modification.
36898 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36899 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36900 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36905 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36906 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36907 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36908 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36909 timestamp. The flags are:
36911 &`<=`& message arrival
36912 &`(=`& message fakereject
36913 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36914 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36915 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36916 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36917 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36918 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36922 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36923 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36924 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36925 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36926 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36928 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36929 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36930 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36932 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36933 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36934 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36938 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36942 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36943 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36944 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36945 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36946 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36947 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36948 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36949 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36950 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36951 name in parentheses.
36953 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36954 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36955 the log containing text like these examples:
36957 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36958 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36960 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36963 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36964 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36967 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36968 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36969 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36970 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36971 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36972 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36973 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36974 suite that was used.
36976 .cindex log protocol
36977 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36978 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36979 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36980 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36981 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36982 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36983 authenticator name.
36985 .cindex "size" "of message"
36986 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36987 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36988 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36989 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36992 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36993 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36997 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36998 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
36999 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37000 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37001 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37002 to fit it on the page:
37004 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37005 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
37006 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37007 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37008 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37010 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37011 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37012 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37013 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37014 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37016 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37017 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37018 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37019 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37021 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37022 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37024 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37026 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37027 parentheses afterwards.
37029 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37030 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37031 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37032 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37033 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37034 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37035 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37036 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37037 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37038 TLS cipher information is still available.
37040 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37041 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37042 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37043 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37044 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37046 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37047 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37049 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37050 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37053 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37054 .cindex "discarded messages"
37055 .cindex "message" "discarded"
37056 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37057 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37058 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37060 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37061 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37063 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37064 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37066 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37067 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37071 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37072 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37074 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37075 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37077 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37078 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37079 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37081 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37082 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37084 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37085 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37086 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37090 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37091 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37092 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37093 following form is logged:
37095 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37096 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37098 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37099 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37101 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37102 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37103 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37104 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37105 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37107 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37108 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37109 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37110 flagged with &`**`&.
37114 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37115 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37116 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37117 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37118 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37122 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
37125 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37127 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37128 at the end of its processing.
37133 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37134 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37135 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37136 the following table:
37138 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37139 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37140 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37141 &`CV `& certificate verification status
37142 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37143 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37144 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37145 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37146 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
37147 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37148 &`H `& host name and IP address
37149 &`I `& local interface used
37150 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37151 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37152 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37153 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37154 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37155 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37156 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37157 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37158 &`Q `& alternate queue name
37159 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37160 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37161 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37162 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37163 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37164 &`S `& size of message in bytes
37165 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37166 &`ST `& shadow transport name
37167 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37168 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37169 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37170 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37171 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
37175 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37176 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37177 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37180 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37181 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37182 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37183 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37184 during the first delivery attempt.
37186 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37187 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37188 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37190 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37191 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37192 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37193 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37194 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37197 .cindex "error" "ignored"
37198 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37201 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37202 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37204 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37205 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37207 A delivery set up by a router configured with
37208 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37209 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37213 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37216 .cindex DKIM "log line"
37217 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37218 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37225 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37226 .cindex "log" "selectors"
37227 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37228 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37229 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37232 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37234 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37235 selection marked by asterisks:
37237 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37238 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37239 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37240 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37241 &` arguments `& command line arguments
37242 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37243 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37244 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
37245 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37246 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37247 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37248 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37249 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37250 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37251 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37252 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37253 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37254 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37255 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37256 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37257 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37258 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37259 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37260 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37261 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37262 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37263 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37264 &` pid `& Exim process id
37265 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37266 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37267 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37268 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37269 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37270 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37271 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37272 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37273 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37274 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37275 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37276 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37277 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37278 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37279 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37280 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37281 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37282 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37283 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37284 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37285 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37286 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37287 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37288 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37289 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37291 &` all `& all of the above
37293 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37294 section &<<SECID99>>&
37296 More details on each of these items follows:
37300 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37301 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37302 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37303 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37304 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37305 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37307 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37308 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37309 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37310 this log selector is set.
37312 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
37313 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37314 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37315 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37316 such users cannot access the log).
37318 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
37319 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37320 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37321 parentheses between them.
37323 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37324 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37325 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37326 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37327 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37328 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37329 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37330 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37331 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37332 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37333 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37334 between the caller and Exim.
37336 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37337 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37338 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37340 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37341 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37342 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37343 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37344 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37345 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37347 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37348 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37349 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37350 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37351 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37353 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37354 .cindex "size" "of message"
37355 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37356 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37358 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37359 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37360 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37361 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37363 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37364 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37365 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37367 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37368 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37369 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
37370 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37371 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37374 .cindex dnssec logging
37375 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37376 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37377 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37378 It does not cover helo-name verification.
37379 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37381 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37382 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37383 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37384 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37385 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37386 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37388 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37389 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37390 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37391 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37392 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37394 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37395 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37396 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37397 client's ident port times out.
37399 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37400 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37401 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37402 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37403 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37404 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37405 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37406 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37407 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37408 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37409 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37411 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37412 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37413 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37414 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37415 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37416 on a proxied connection
37417 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37418 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37420 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37421 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
37422 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37423 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37424 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37425 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37426 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37427 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37428 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37429 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37430 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37432 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37433 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37434 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37436 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37437 .cindex millisecond logging
37438 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37439 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37440 appended to the seconds value.
37443 .cindex "log" "message id"
37444 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37446 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37447 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37448 (submission mode) without one.
37449 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37452 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37453 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37454 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37455 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37456 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37457 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37458 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37459 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37460 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37462 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37463 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37464 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37465 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37466 containing => tags) following the IP address.
37467 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37468 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37469 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37470 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37471 local port is a random ephemeral port.
37473 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37474 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37475 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37476 immediately after the time and date.
37478 .cindex log pipelining
37479 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37480 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37481 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37482 The field is a single "L".
37484 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37485 the field has a minus appended.
37488 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
37489 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
37490 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
37491 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
37492 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
37496 .cindex "log" "queue run"
37497 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37498 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37500 .cindex "log" "queue time"
37501 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37502 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37503 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37504 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37505 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37506 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37507 message has been successfully received.
37508 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37509 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37511 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37512 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37513 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37514 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37516 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
37517 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37518 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37519 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37520 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37522 .cindex "log" "recipients"
37523 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37524 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37525 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37526 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37528 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37531 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
37532 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37533 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37534 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37536 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37537 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37538 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37539 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37540 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37542 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
37543 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37544 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37545 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37548 .cindex "log" "return path"
37549 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37550 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37551 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37552 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37554 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37555 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37556 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37557 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37558 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37560 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37561 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37562 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37563 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37566 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
37567 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37570 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37571 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37572 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37573 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37575 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37576 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37578 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37579 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37580 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37581 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37582 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37583 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37586 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37587 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37588 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37589 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37590 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37591 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37592 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37593 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37594 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37595 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37597 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37598 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37599 reset if the daemon is restarted.
37600 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37601 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37602 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37603 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37604 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37606 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37607 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37608 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37609 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37610 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37611 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37613 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37614 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37615 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37616 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37617 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37618 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37619 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37620 already have their own log lines.
37622 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37623 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37624 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37625 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37626 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37627 the same logging options.
37629 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37630 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37634 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37635 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37636 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37637 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37638 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37640 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37641 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37642 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37643 was accepted or used.
37645 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37646 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37647 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37648 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37649 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37650 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37651 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37652 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37654 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37655 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37656 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37657 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37658 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37659 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37660 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37661 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37662 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37664 .cindex "log" "subject"
37665 .cindex "subject, logging"
37666 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37667 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37668 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37669 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37670 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37672 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37674 .cindex DANE logging
37675 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37676 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37678 using a CA trust anchor,
37679 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37680 and &`CV=no`& if not.
37682 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37683 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37684 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37685 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37687 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37688 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37689 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37690 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37691 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37693 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37694 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37695 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37696 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37697 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37699 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37700 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37701 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37705 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
37706 .cindex "message" "log file for"
37707 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37708 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37709 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37710 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37711 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37712 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37713 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37714 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37715 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37716 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37717 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37719 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37720 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37721 &%message_logs%& option false.
37727 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37728 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37730 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37731 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37732 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37733 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37734 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37736 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37737 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37738 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37739 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37740 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37741 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37742 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37744 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37745 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37746 "extract statistics from the log"
37747 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37748 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37749 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37750 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37751 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37752 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37753 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37754 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37757 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37758 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37759 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37764 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37765 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37766 .cindex "process, querying"
37768 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37769 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37770 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37771 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37772 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37773 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37774 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37775 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37777 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37778 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37779 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37782 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37783 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37784 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37785 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37786 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37789 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37790 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37791 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37792 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37794 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37796 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
37797 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
37798 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37799 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
37800 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
37801 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37803 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37804 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37808 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37809 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37810 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
37811 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37815 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37819 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37820 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37822 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37823 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37826 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37827 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37828 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37832 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37833 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37834 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37836 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37837 Match against the size field.
37839 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37840 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37842 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37843 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37846 Match only frozen messages.
37849 Match only non-frozen messages.
37852 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
37853 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
37857 The following options control the format of the output:
37861 Display only the count of matching messages.
37864 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37868 Display message ids only.
37871 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37874 Display messages in reverse order.
37877 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37880 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37884 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37885 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37886 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37887 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37888 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
37889 running a command such as
37891 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37893 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37894 it, as in the following example:
37896 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37898 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37899 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37900 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37901 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37903 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37904 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37905 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37906 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37907 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37908 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37911 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37912 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37913 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37914 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37915 level"& addresses).
37920 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37922 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37923 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37924 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37925 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37926 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37927 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37928 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37929 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37930 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37931 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37933 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37935 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37937 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37938 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37939 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
37941 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37942 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37943 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37944 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37945 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37947 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37948 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37949 regular expression.
37951 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37952 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37954 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37955 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37959 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37960 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37961 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37962 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37963 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37964 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37967 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37968 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37969 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37970 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37971 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37974 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37975 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37976 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37977 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37978 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37979 the &%--help%& option.
37982 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37983 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37984 .cindex "cycling logs"
37985 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37986 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37987 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37988 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37989 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37990 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37991 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37993 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37994 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37996 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37997 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37998 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38002 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38003 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38004 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38005 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38006 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38007 logs are handled similarly.
38009 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38010 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38011 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38012 any existing log files.
38014 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38015 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38016 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38017 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38018 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38020 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38022 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38023 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38027 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38028 .cindex "statistics"
38029 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38030 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38031 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38032 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38033 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38035 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38036 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38037 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38038 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38039 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38041 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38043 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38044 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38045 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38046 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38047 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38048 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38049 also produced per user.
38051 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38052 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38053 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38054 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38055 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38057 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38058 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38059 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38060 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38061 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38062 an entirely separate message.
38064 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38065 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38066 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38067 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38068 least one address that failed.
38070 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38071 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38072 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38073 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38074 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38075 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38076 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38078 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38079 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38080 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38082 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38083 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38084 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38086 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38089 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38090 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38091 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38092 .cindex "checking access"
38093 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38094 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38095 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38096 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38097 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38098 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38100 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38101 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38103 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38105 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38106 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38107 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38108 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38111 550 Relay not permitted
38113 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38114 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38115 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38116 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38119 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38120 -f himself@there.example
38122 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38123 mandatory arguments.
38125 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38126 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38127 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38131 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38132 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38133 .cindex "building DBM files"
38134 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38135 .cindex "lower casing"
38136 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38137 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38138 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38139 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38140 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38141 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38143 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38144 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38145 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38146 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38149 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38150 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38151 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38155 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38156 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38157 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38158 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38160 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38162 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38163 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38165 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38166 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38167 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38168 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38169 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38170 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38172 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38173 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38174 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38175 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38176 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38177 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38178 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38184 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38185 .cindex "retry" "times"
38186 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
38187 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38188 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38189 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38190 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38191 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38192 output. For example:
38194 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38195 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38196 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38197 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38198 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38199 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38200 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38201 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38202 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38203 past final cutoff time
38205 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38206 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38207 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38208 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38209 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38210 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38213 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38214 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38215 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38216 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38217 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38218 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38222 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38223 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38224 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38225 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38226 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38227 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38228 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38231 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
38233 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38236 &'callout'&: the callout cache
38238 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38240 &'misc'&: other hints data
38243 The &'misc'& database is used for
38246 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38248 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38249 &(smtp)& transport)
38251 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38257 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38258 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38259 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38260 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38261 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38263 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38265 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38267 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
38268 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38270 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38271 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38272 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38273 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38274 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38275 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38276 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38277 and a textual description of the error.
38279 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38280 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38281 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38284 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38285 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38286 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38287 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38288 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38289 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38294 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38295 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38296 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38297 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38298 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38299 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38300 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38301 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38302 updated sufficiently often.
38304 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38305 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38306 the retry database:
38308 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38310 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38311 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38312 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38313 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38314 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38315 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38316 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38317 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38318 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38319 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38320 whenever it removes information from the database.
38322 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38323 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38324 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38325 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38326 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38328 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38329 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38330 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38331 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38332 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38333 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38334 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38337 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38338 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38343 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38344 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38345 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38346 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38347 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38348 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38349 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38352 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38353 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38354 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38355 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38356 by new data, for example:
38360 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38361 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38362 used as optional separators.
38367 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38368 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38369 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38370 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
38371 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38372 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38373 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38374 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38375 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38376 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38377 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38378 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38379 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38383 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38386 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38389 .vitem &%-interval%&
38390 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38391 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38393 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
38394 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38397 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38400 Suppress verification output.
38402 .vitem &%-retries%&
38403 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38404 the lock (default 10).
38406 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
38407 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38408 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38409 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38412 .vitem &%-timeout%&
38413 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38414 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38415 default), a non-blocking call is used.
38418 Generate verbose output.
38421 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38422 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38423 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38424 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38425 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38426 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38427 more than 30 minutes old.
38429 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38430 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38431 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38432 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38433 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38434 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38436 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38437 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38438 suppresses all output except error messages.
38442 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38444 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38446 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38447 <&'some commands'&>
38450 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38451 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38454 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38455 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38457 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38458 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38463 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38465 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38466 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38467 .cindex "X-windows"
38468 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
38469 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38470 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38471 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38472 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38473 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38474 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38475 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38479 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38480 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38481 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38482 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38483 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38484 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38485 parameters are for.
38487 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38488 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38489 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38491 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38493 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38494 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38495 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38496 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38497 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38499 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38500 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38502 Eximon*background: gray94
38504 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38505 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38506 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38507 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38508 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38509 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38510 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38513 Eximon*highlight: gray
38516 .cindex "admin user"
38517 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38518 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38520 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38521 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38522 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38523 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38524 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38526 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38527 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38528 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38529 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38530 different parts of the display.
38535 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38536 .cindex "stripchart"
38537 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38538 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38539 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38540 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38541 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38542 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38543 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38544 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38545 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38547 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38548 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38549 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38550 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38552 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38553 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38554 to a single partition.
38556 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38557 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38558 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38559 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38560 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38561 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38562 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38567 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38568 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38569 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38570 .cindex "window size"
38571 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38572 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38573 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38574 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38575 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38576 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38578 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38579 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38580 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38581 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38583 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38584 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38585 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38586 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38587 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38588 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38590 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38591 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38592 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38596 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
38597 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38598 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38599 the main log is maintained.
38600 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38601 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38602 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38603 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38604 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38606 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38607 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38608 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38609 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38610 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38611 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38612 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38613 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38614 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38615 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38616 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38618 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38619 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38620 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38621 It cannot go further back up the log.
38623 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38624 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38625 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38626 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38627 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38628 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38630 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38631 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38632 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38633 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38634 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38635 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38637 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38638 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38639 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38640 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38641 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38642 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38643 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38644 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38645 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38650 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38651 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38652 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38653 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38654 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38655 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38656 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38657 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38658 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38659 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38661 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38662 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38663 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38664 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38665 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38666 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38667 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38669 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38670 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38671 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38672 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38673 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38674 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38675 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38677 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38678 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38679 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38680 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38682 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38683 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38684 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38685 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38686 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38687 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38688 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38691 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38692 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38694 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38695 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38696 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38697 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38698 display is updated.
38702 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38703 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38704 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38705 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38706 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38709 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38710 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38711 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38712 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38713 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38715 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38717 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38721 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38722 in a new text window.
38724 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38725 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38726 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38728 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38729 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38730 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38731 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38733 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38734 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38735 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38736 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38737 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38739 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38740 that the message be frozen.
38742 .cindex "thawing messages"
38743 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
38744 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38745 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38746 that the message be thawed.
38748 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38749 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38750 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38751 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38753 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38754 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38757 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38758 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38759 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38760 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38761 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38762 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38763 which case no action is taken.
38765 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38766 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38767 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38768 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38769 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38770 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38771 case no action is taken.
38773 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38774 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38776 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38777 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38778 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38779 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38780 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38781 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38782 the address is qualified with that domain.
38785 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38786 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38787 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38788 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38789 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38790 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38791 if no output is generated.
38793 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38794 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38795 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38796 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38798 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38799 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38800 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38807 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38808 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38810 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38811 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38812 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38813 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38815 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38816 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38817 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38818 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38819 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38820 its security as compared with other MTAs.
38822 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38823 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38824 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38825 as soon as possible.
38828 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38829 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
38830 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38831 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38832 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38833 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38836 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38837 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
38838 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
38839 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38840 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38841 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38843 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38844 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38845 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38846 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38849 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38850 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38851 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38852 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38853 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38854 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38855 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38856 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38857 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38861 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38862 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38863 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38864 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38865 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38866 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38867 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38869 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38872 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38873 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38874 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38875 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38876 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38881 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38883 .cindex "root privilege"
38884 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38885 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38886 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38887 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38888 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38889 is required for two things:
38892 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38893 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38896 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38897 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38901 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38902 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38903 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38904 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38905 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38906 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
38907 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38908 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38910 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38911 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38912 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38914 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38915 uid and gid in the following cases:
38920 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38921 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38922 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38923 the calling process.
38924 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38925 option may not be used at all.
38926 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38927 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38928 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38933 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38934 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38937 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38938 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38939 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38940 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38941 testing address verification
38944 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38947 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38948 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38951 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38954 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38955 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38956 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38957 will be used during message reception.
38959 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38960 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38962 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38963 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38964 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38965 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38966 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38967 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38968 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38969 generating bounce and warning messages.
38971 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38972 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38973 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38974 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38976 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38977 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38983 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38984 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38985 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38986 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38987 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38988 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38989 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38990 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38991 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38992 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38996 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38997 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38998 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38999 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39001 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39002 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39003 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39004 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39005 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39007 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39008 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39009 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39012 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39013 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39014 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39016 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39017 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39018 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39019 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39020 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39021 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39022 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39023 address this problem at this time.
39025 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39026 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39027 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39028 be used in the most straightforward way.
39030 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39031 number of restrictions on what you can do:
39034 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39035 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39036 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39037 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39038 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39040 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39041 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39043 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39044 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39045 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39046 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39048 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39049 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39052 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39053 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39054 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39056 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39057 owned by the Exim user.
39059 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39060 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39061 mailboxes need to be created manually.
39066 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39067 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39068 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39069 gives more security at essentially no cost.
39071 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39072 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39077 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39078 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39079 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39083 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39084 .cindex "security" "local commands"
39085 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39086 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39087 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39088 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39089 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39092 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39093 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39094 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39095 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39096 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39098 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39099 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39100 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39101 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39102 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39103 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39104 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39106 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39107 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39108 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39110 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39111 taint checking might apply to their usage.
39113 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39114 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39115 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39117 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39118 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39119 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39121 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39122 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39123 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39124 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39130 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39131 .cindex "security" "data sources"
39132 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39133 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39134 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
39135 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39136 are some issues to be aware of:
39139 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39141 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39143 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39144 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39145 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39146 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39147 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39148 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39151 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39152 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39153 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39155 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39156 expected to yield one result.
39162 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39163 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39164 .cindex "IP source routing"
39165 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39166 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39167 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39168 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39172 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39173 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39174 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39179 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39180 .cindex "trusted users"
39181 .cindex "admin user"
39182 .cindex "privileged user"
39183 .cindex "user" "trusted"
39184 .cindex "user" "admin"
39185 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39186 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39187 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39188 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39189 permit a remote host to be specified.
39192 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39193 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39194 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39195 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39196 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39197 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39199 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39200 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39201 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39202 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39203 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39205 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39206 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39207 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39208 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39209 includes the contents of files on the spool.
39213 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39214 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39215 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39216 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39217 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39218 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39220 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39221 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39222 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39223 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39224 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39225 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39228 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39229 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39230 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39231 This affects most of the checking options,
39232 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39235 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39236 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
39237 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39238 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39239 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39240 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39244 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39245 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39246 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39247 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39248 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39253 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39254 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39255 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39256 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39261 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39262 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39263 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39264 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39265 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39269 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39270 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39271 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39275 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39276 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39277 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39278 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39279 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39280 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39281 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39283 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39284 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39289 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39290 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39291 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39292 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39296 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39297 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39298 enough to hold the result.
39299 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
39304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39307 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39308 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39309 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39310 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39311 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
39312 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39313 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39314 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39315 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39316 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39317 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39318 themselves are recoverable.
39320 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39321 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39322 and should not be used as such.
39324 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39325 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39326 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39329 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39330 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39331 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39332 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39333 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39335 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39336 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39337 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39338 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39340 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39342 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39345 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39347 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39348 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39349 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39350 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39351 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39352 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39353 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39354 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39357 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39358 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39359 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39360 relics of crashes and can be removed.
39362 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39363 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39364 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39365 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39366 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39367 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39368 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39369 normally the Exim user.
39371 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39372 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39373 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39374 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39375 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39376 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39377 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39378 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39380 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39381 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39382 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39383 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39385 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39386 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39389 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39390 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39391 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39392 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39393 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39394 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39395 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39396 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39397 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39400 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39401 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39402 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39403 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39404 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39405 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39407 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39408 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39409 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39410 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39411 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39412 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39414 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39415 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39416 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39418 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39419 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39420 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39421 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39422 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39424 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39425 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39426 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39427 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39428 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39430 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39431 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39432 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39434 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39435 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39436 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39438 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39439 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39440 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39442 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39443 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39444 present if the number is greater than zero.
39446 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39447 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39448 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39450 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39451 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39452 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39454 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39455 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39458 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39459 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39460 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39463 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39464 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39465 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39466 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39468 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39469 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39470 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39472 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39473 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39474 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39475 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39476 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39477 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39479 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39480 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39481 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39482 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39483 supplied by the remote host, if any.
39485 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39486 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39487 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39488 generated messages.
39491 The message is from a local sender.
39493 .vitem &%-localerror%&
39494 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39496 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39497 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39498 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39499 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39501 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39502 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39503 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39506 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39507 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39510 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39511 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39512 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39514 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39515 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39516 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39518 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39519 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39520 of &$spam_score_int$&.
39522 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39523 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39524 rather than Unix-format.
39525 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39526 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39528 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39529 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39530 certificate was verified by the server.
39532 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39533 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39534 name of the cipher suite that was used.
39536 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39537 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39538 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39542 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39543 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39544 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39545 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39546 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39547 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39548 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39549 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39550 addresses are complete.
39552 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39553 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39554 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39555 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39556 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39557 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39559 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39560 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39561 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39563 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39564 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39565 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39566 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39570 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39571 darcy@austen.fict.example
39573 alice@wonderland.fict.example
39575 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39576 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39577 line is of the following form:
39579 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39580 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39582 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39583 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39584 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39585 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39586 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39587 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39588 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39589 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39592 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39593 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39594 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39595 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39596 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39600 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39601 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39602 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39603 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39604 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39605 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39606 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39607 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39608 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39609 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39612 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39613 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39614 typical set of headers:
39616 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39617 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39618 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39619 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39620 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39621 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39622 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39623 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39624 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39625 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39626 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39628 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39629 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39630 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39631 .ecindex IIDforspo1
39632 .ecindex IIDforspo2
39633 .ecindex IIDforspo3
39635 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39636 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39637 an ASCII newline character.
39638 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39639 can have an alternate format.
39640 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39641 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39642 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39643 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39644 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39645 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39647 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39648 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39650 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39651 "DKIM and SPF Support"
39654 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39656 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39657 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39658 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39659 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39661 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39662 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39663 any original DKIM signature.
39665 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39666 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39668 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39670 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39671 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39672 (including transport filters)
39673 except cutthrough delivery.
39675 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39676 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39677 different signature contexts.
39680 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39681 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39682 Exim's standard controls.
39684 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39685 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39687 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39688 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39689 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39690 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39692 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39693 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39694 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39695 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39698 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39699 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39700 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39701 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39705 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39706 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39708 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39709 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39711 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39713 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39714 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39717 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39718 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39719 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39720 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39721 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39723 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39724 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39726 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39727 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39728 After expansion, this can be a list.
39729 Each element in turn,
39733 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39734 while expanding the remaining signing options.
39735 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39736 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39738 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39739 This sets the key selector string.
39740 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39741 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39742 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39743 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39744 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39745 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39747 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39748 This sets the private key to use.
39749 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39750 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39751 The result can either
39753 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39755 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39756 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39758 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39761 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39762 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39766 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39768 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39769 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39771 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39772 for the DNS TXT record.
39773 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39777 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39778 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39781 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39783 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39784 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39788 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
39790 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39791 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39792 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39793 for some transition period.
39794 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39797 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39799 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39800 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39803 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39805 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39806 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39810 Exim also supports an alternate format
39811 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
39812 of the standard, but not adopted.
39813 A future release will probably drop that support.
39816 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39817 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39819 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39821 &`sha256`& &-- the default
39823 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39826 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39828 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39831 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39832 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39833 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39834 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39835 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39836 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39838 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39839 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39840 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39841 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39842 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39844 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39845 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39846 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39847 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39848 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39851 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39852 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39853 list of header names.
39854 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39855 in the message signature.
39856 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39857 whether or not each header is present in the message.
39858 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39859 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39861 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39862 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39863 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39865 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39866 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39868 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39869 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39870 name will be appended.
39872 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
39873 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
39874 If not set, no such information will be included.
39875 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
39877 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
39878 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
39880 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
39883 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39884 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39886 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
39887 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
39888 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39889 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39890 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39892 The results of that verification are then made available to the
39893 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
39894 By default, this ACL is called once for each
39895 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39896 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39897 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39898 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39899 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39901 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
39902 a large number of expansion variables
39903 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39904 runtime of the ACL.
39906 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39907 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39908 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39909 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39911 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39912 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39913 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39914 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39915 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39916 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39919 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39921 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39922 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39923 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39925 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39927 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39928 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39929 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39931 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39934 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39935 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39938 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
39939 (such as the From: header)
39940 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
39941 and for the domain part if identities.
39942 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
39945 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39946 for each matching signature.
39949 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39950 available (from most to least important):
39954 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39955 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39956 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39957 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39959 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39960 Within the DKIM ACL,
39961 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39963 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39964 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39966 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39967 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39969 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39970 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39972 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39975 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39976 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39977 hash-method or key-size:
39979 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39980 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
39981 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39982 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
39983 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
39984 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39985 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39988 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
39989 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39990 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39991 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
39993 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39994 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39995 "fail" or "invalid". One of
39997 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39998 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40000 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40001 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40003 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40004 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40005 means that the message body was modified in transit.
40007 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40008 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40009 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40010 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40013 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40015 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40016 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40017 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40018 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40020 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40021 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40022 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40023 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40025 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40026 The key record selector string.
40028 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40029 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40030 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40031 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40032 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40035 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40037 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40039 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40040 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40043 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40044 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40046 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40047 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40049 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40050 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40052 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40053 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40054 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40055 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40056 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40057 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40059 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40060 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40061 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40062 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40063 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40064 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40065 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40066 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40068 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40069 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40070 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40072 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40073 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40074 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40075 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40076 integer size comparisons against this value.
40077 Note that Exim does not check this value.
40079 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40080 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40082 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40083 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40085 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40086 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40088 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40089 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40092 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40093 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40096 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40097 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40099 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40100 Number of bits in the key.
40102 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40104 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40105 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40108 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40109 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40110 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40114 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40117 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40118 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40119 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40120 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40121 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40124 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40125 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40126 sender_domains = gmail.com
40127 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40131 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40132 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40134 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
40135 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40136 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40137 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40140 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40141 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40142 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40143 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40146 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40147 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40148 for more information of what they mean.
40154 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40155 .cindex SPF verification
40157 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40158 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40159 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
40160 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https
40162 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40163 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40165 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40166 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40167 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40168 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40169 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40171 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40172 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40173 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40174 &$authresults$& expansion item.
40177 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40178 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
40179 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40180 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40181 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40185 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40188 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40189 domain in the envelope-from address.
40191 .vitem &%softfail%&
40192 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40196 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40199 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40200 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40201 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40203 .vitem &%permerror%&
40204 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40205 You may deny messages when this occurs.
40207 .vitem &%temperror%&
40208 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40209 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40212 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40213 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40214 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40215 short-circuit fashion.
40220 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40221 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40222 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40223 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
40224 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40225 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40226 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40227 ip=$sender_host_address
40230 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40233 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
40235 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40236 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40237 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40238 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40239 it for logging purposes.
40241 .vitem &$spf_received$&
40242 .vindex &$spf_received$&
40243 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40244 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40245 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40246 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40248 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40249 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40251 .vitem &$spf_result$&
40252 .vindex &$spf_result$&
40253 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40254 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40257 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40258 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40259 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40260 and required in order to obtain a result.
40262 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40263 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40264 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40265 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40269 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40270 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40271 .cindex SPF "best guess"
40272 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40273 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40274 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40276 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40277 for a description of what it means.
40278 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https:
40280 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40281 of the spf one. For example:
40284 deny spf_guess = fail
40285 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40288 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40289 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40290 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40293 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40294 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40296 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40297 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40298 &%spf_guess%& option.
40299 For example, the following:
40302 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40305 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40308 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40310 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40311 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
40314 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40317 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40318 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40319 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
40324 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40325 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40327 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40329 .cindex "proxy support"
40330 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
40332 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40333 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40336 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40337 .cindex proxy inbound
40338 .cindex proxy "server side"
40339 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40340 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40342 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40343 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40344 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40347 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40348 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40350 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40351 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40352 to distribute load.
40353 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40354 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40355 There is no logging if a host passes or
40356 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40357 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40359 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40360 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40361 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40362 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40363 automatically determines which version is in use.
40365 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40366 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40367 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40368 Exim and the proxy server.
40370 The following expansion variables are usable
40371 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40374 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40375 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40376 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40377 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40378 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40380 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40381 there was a protocol error.
40382 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40383 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40385 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40386 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40387 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40388 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40389 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40390 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40391 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40392 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40393 A possible solution is:
40395 # Set max number of connections per host
40397 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40398 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40400 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40401 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40406 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40407 .cindex proxy outbound
40408 .cindex proxy "client side"
40409 .cindex proxy SOCKS
40410 .cindex SOCKS proxy
40411 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40412 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40413 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40416 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40417 on an smtp transport.
40418 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40419 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40420 Each proxy specifier is a list
40421 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
40422 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40424 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40425 The list of options is in the following table:
40427 &'auth '& authentication method
40428 &'name '& authentication username
40429 &'pass '& authentication password
40431 &'tmo '& connection timeout
40433 &'weight '& selection bias
40436 More details on each of these options follows:
40439 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
40440 .cindex proxy authentication
40441 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40442 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40443 for access to the proxy.
40444 Default is &"none"&.
40446 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40449 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40452 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40455 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40458 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40459 higher values being tried first.
40460 The default priority is 1.
40462 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40463 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40464 weighted by this value.
40465 The default value for selection bias is 1.
40468 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40469 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40470 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40472 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
40473 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40474 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40475 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40477 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40478 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40480 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40481 "Internationalisation""
40482 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
40485 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40487 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
40488 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
40489 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
40491 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
40492 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
40493 requirement, upon libidn2.
40495 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
40496 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
40497 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
40498 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
40499 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
40500 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
40502 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
40503 international handling for the message is enabled and
40504 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
40506 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
40507 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
40508 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
40509 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
40511 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
40512 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
40513 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
40514 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
40516 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
40517 components expanded to a-label form,
40518 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
40521 .cindex log protocol
40522 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
40523 .cindex i18n logging
40524 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
40525 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
40527 The following expansion operators can be used:
40529 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
40530 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
40531 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
40532 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
40535 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
40536 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
40538 may use the following modifier:
40540 control = utf8_downconvert
40541 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
40543 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
40544 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
40545 Message Submission Agent context.
40546 If a value is appended it may be:
40548 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
40549 &`0 `& no downconversion
40550 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
40553 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
40554 is initially set to -1.
40556 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
40557 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
40558 and it overrides any previously set value.
40561 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
40562 Configurations supporting these should inspect
40563 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
40565 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
40566 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
40567 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
40569 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
40570 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
40574 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
40575 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
40576 the following expansion operator can be used:
40578 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
40581 The string is converted from the charset specified by
40582 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
40583 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
40585 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
40586 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
40587 (which has to be a single character)
40588 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
40589 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
40591 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
40592 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
40594 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
40595 by many other IMAP servers.
40599 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
40600 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
40601 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
40604 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
40605 must be representable in UTF-16.
40608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40611 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
40615 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
40616 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
40617 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
40618 processing actions.
40620 Most installations will never need to use Events.
40621 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
40622 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40624 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
40625 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
40626 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
40628 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
40629 An example might look like:
40630 .cindex logging custom
40632 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
40633 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
40634 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
40635 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
40636 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
40637 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
40638 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
40639 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
40640 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
40644 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
40645 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
40646 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
40648 The current list of events is:
40650 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
40651 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
40652 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40653 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
40654 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
40655 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
40656 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40657 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
40658 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
40659 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
40660 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
40661 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
40663 New event types may be added in future.
40665 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
40666 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
40667 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
40669 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
40670 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
40671 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
40673 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
40674 should define the event action.
40676 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
40677 with the event type:
40679 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
40680 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
40681 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
40682 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
40683 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
40684 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
40685 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
40686 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
40687 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
40690 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
40692 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
40693 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
40694 the course of its processing:
40696 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
40699 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
40700 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
40702 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
40703 a useful way of writing to the main log.
40705 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
40706 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
40707 following will be forced:
40709 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
40710 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
40711 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
40713 All other message types ignore the result string, and
40714 no other use is made of it.
40716 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
40717 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
40720 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
40721 chain element received on the connection.
40722 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
40725 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40726 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40728 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
40729 "Adding drivers or lookups"
40730 .cindex "adding drivers"
40731 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
40732 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
40733 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
40734 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
40737 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
40738 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
40740 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
40742 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
40744 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
40745 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
40746 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
40748 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
40750 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
40753 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
40754 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
40756 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
40757 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
40758 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
40759 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
40760 simple form that most lookups have.
40762 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
40763 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
40764 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
40766 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
40767 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
40769 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
40772 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
40773 as for other drivers and lookups.
40776 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
40777 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
40778 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
40779 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
40780 searched using a binary chop procedure.
40782 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
40783 the interface that is expected.
40788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40791 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40792 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
40793 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
40794 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
40796 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40801 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
40802 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
40806 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
40807 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
40808 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
40811 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40812 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////